blob: 5a815a175caa47dca1fb59fd776cd89bae8536ff [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau8234f6d2016-03-14 00:10:05 +01007 2016/03/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200566 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200568 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100569 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100570 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200572 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200573 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200574 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - noepoll
577 - nokqueue
578 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300580 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200581 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200582 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200583 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - tune.buffers.limit
585 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200586 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200587 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100588 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100589 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200590 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100591 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100592 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100593 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100594 - tune.lua.session-timeout
595 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200596 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100597 - tune.maxaccept
598 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200600 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200601 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100602 - tune.rcvbuf.client
603 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100604 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100605 - tune.sndbuf.client
606 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100607 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100608 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200609 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100610 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200611 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200612 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200613 - tune.vars.global-max-size
614 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
615 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
616 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100617 - tune.zlib.memlevel
618 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100619
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 * Debugging
621 - debug
622 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623
624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006253.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200626------------------------------------
627
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200628ca-base <dir>
629 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200630 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
631 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633chroot <jail dir>
634 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
635 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
636 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
637 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
638 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
639 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100640
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100641cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
642 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
643 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
644 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100645 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
646 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
647 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
648 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
649 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
650 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
651 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
652 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
653 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
654 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100655
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200656crt-base <dir>
657 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
658 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
659 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
660
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200661daemon
662 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
663 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
664 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
665
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200666deviceatlas-json-file <path>
667 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
668 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
669
670deviceatlas-log-level <value>
671 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
672 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
673
674deviceatlas-separator <char>
675 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
676 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
677
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100678deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200679 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
680 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
681 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100682
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900683external-check
684 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
685 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
686 See "option external-check".
687
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200688gid <number>
689 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
690 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
691 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100692 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
693 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200694 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696group <group name>
697 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
698 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100699
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200700log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
702 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100703 configured with "log global".
704
705 <address> can be one of:
706
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100707 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100708 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
709 port).
710
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100711 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
712 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
713 port).
714
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100715 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
716 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
717 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
718 writeable).
719
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200720 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
721 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100722
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200723 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
724 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
725 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
726 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
727 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
728 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
729 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
730 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
731 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
732 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
733 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
734
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200735 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
736 one of the following :
737
738 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
739 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
740
741 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
742 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
743
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100744 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200745
746 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
747 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
748 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
749
750 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200751 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
752 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
753 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
754 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
755 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
756 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200757
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200758 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200759
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100760log-send-hostname [<string>]
761 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
762 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
763 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
764 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
765 the logs.
766
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000767log-tag <string>
768 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
769 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
770 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100771 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000772
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100773lua-load <file>
774 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
775 used multiple times.
776
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200777nbproc <number>
778 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
779 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
780 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
781 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
782 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
783
784pidfile <pidfile>
785 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
786 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
787 starting the process. See also "daemon".
788
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100789presetenv <name> <value>
790 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
791 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
792 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
793 and "unsetenv".
794
795resetenv [<name> ...]
796 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
797 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
798 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
799 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
800 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
801 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
802 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
803 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
804
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100805stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200806 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
807 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
808 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
809 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
810 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
811 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100812 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200813 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
814 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200815
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200816server-state-base <directory>
817 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200818 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
819 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200820
821server-state-file <file>
822 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
823 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
824 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
825 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
826 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
827 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
828 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
829 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200830 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
831 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200832
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100833setenv <name> <value>
834 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
835 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
836 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
837 and "unsetenv".
838
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100839ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
841 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300842 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100843 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
844 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
845 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
846 "bind" keyword for more information.
847
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100848ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
850 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
851 keyword to see available options.
852
853 Example:
854 global
855 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
856
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100857ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
858 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
859 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300860 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100861 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
862 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
863 information.
864
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100865ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
866 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
867 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
868 keyword to see available options.
869
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200870ssl-dh-param-file <file>
871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
872 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
873 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
874 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
875 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200876 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
877 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
878 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
879 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200880 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
881 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
882 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
883
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100884ssl-server-verify [none|required]
885 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
886 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
887 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
888
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200889stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
890 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
891 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
892 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200893 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
894 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200895
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200896 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
897 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
898 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200899
900stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
901 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
902 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100903 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200904
905stats maxconn <connections>
906 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
907 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
908
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200909uid <number>
910 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
911 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
912 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
913 one. See also "gid" and "user".
914
915ulimit-n <number>
916 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
917 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
918 option.
919
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100920unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
921 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
922
923 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
924 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
925 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
926 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
927 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
928 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
929 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
930 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
931 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
932 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
933
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100934unsetenv [<name> ...]
935 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
936 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
937 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
938 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
939 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
940 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
941 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
942
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200943user <user name>
944 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
945 See also "uid" and "group".
946
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200947node <name>
948 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
949
950 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
951 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
952 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
953 traffic.
954
955description <text>
956 Add a text that describes the instance.
957
958 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
959 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
960 "<" and ">" characters.
961
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096251degrees-data-file <file path>
963 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
964 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
965
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200966 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100967 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
968
96951degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
970 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
971 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
972 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
973
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200974 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100975 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
976
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100978 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
979 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
980
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200981 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
982 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
983
98451degrees-cache-size <number>
985 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
986 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
987 By default, this cache is disabled.
988
989 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100990 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200992
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009933.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994-----------------------
995
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200996max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
997 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
998 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
999 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1000 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1001 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1002 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1003 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1004 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1005
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006maxconn <number>
1007 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1008 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1009 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001010 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1011 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1012 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1013 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001014 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1015 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1016 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1017 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1018 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001020maxconnrate <number>
1021 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1022 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1023 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1024 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1025 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1026 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1027 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1028 fairness.
1029
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001030maxcomprate <number>
1031 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001032 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001033 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1034 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1035 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1036 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1037 default value.
1038
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001039maxcompcpuusage <number>
1040 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1041 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1042 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1043 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1044 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1045 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1046 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1047 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1048
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001049maxpipes <number>
1050 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1051 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1052 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1053 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1054 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1055 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1056
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001057maxsessrate <number>
1058 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1059 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1060 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1061 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1062 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1063 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1064 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1065 fairness.
1066
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001067maxsslconn <number>
1068 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1069 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1070 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1071 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1072 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1073 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1074 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001075 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1076 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1077 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1078 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1079 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1080 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1081 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001082
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001083maxsslrate <number>
1084 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1085 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1086 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1087 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1088 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1089 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1090 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1091 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1092 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1093 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1094
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001095maxzlibmem <number>
1096 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1097 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1098 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001099 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1100 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1101 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001103noepoll
1104 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1105 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001106 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107
1108nokqueue
1109 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1110 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1111 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1112
1113nopoll
1114 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1115 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001116 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001117 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001119nosplice
1120 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1121 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1122 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001123 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001124 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1125 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1126 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1127 "option splice-response".
1128
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001129nogetaddrinfo
1130 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1131 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1132
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001133spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001134 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1135 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1136 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1137 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1138 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1139 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001140
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001141tune.buffers.limit <number>
1142 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1143 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1144 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1145 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1146 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1147 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1148 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1149 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1150 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1151 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1152 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1153 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1154 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1155 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1156 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1157
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001158tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1159 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1160 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1161 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1162 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1163
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001164tune.bufsize <number>
1165 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1166 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1167 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1168 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1169 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1170 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1171 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1172 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001173 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1174 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1175 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001176
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001177tune.chksize <number>
1178 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1179 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1180 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1181 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1182 checks whenever possible.
1183
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001184tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1185 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1186 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1187 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1188 this value. The default value is 1.
1189
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001190tune.http.cookielen <number>
1191 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1192 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1193 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1194 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1195 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1196 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1197 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1198 to change this value.
1199
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001200tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1201 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1202 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1203 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1204 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1205 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1206 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1207 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1208 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1209 limit too high.
1210
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001211tune.idletimer <timeout>
1212 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1213 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1214 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1215 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1216 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1217 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1218 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1219 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1220 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1221
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001222tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1223 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1224 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1225 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1226 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1227 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1228 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1229 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1230
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001231tune.lua.maxmem
1232 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1233 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1234 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1235 memory.
1236
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001237tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1238 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001239 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1240 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1241 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001242
1243tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1244 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1245 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1246 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1247 check servers.
1248
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001249tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1250 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1251 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1252 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1253 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1254
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001255tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001256 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1257 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1258 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1259 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1260 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1261 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1262 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1263 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1264 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1265 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001266
1267tune.maxpollevents <number>
1268 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1269 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1270 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1271 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1272 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1273
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001274tune.maxrewrite <number>
1275 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1276 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1277 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1278 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1279 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1280 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1281 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1282 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1283 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1284 bufsize.
1285
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001286tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1287 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1288 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1289 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1290 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1291 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1292 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1293 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1294 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1295 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1296 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1297 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1298 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1299 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1300 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1301 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1302 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1303 setting this parameter to 0.
1304
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001305tune.pipesize <number>
1306 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1307 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1308 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1309 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1310 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1311 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1312
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001313tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1314tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1315 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1316 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1317 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1318 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1319 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1320 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1321 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1322
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001323tune.recv_enough <number>
1324 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1325 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1326 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1327 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1328 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1329
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001330tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1331tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1332 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1333 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1334 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1335 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1336 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1337 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1338 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1339 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1340 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1341 notifying haproxy again.
1342
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001343tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001344 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1345 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1346 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001347 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001348 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1349 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1350 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1351 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1352 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001353 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1354 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001355
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001356tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1357 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1358 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1359 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1360 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1361 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1362 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1363
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001364tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1365 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001366 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001367 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1368 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1369 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1370 being used for too long.
1371
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001372tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1373 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1374 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1375 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1376 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1377 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1378 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1379 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1380 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1381 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1382 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001383 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1384 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001385
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001386tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1387 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1388 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1389 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1390 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1391 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1392 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1393 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001394 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1395 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001396
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001397tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1398 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1399 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1400 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1401 1000 entries.
1402
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001403tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1404tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1405tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1406tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001407 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1408 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1409 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1410 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1411 response processing.
1412 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1413 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1414 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001415
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001416 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1417 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1418 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1419 all available space is consumed.
1420 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1421 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1422 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001423
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001424tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1425 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001426 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001427 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1428 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1429 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1430
1431tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1432 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1433 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1434 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1435 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014373.3. Debugging
1438--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
1440debug
1441 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1442 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1443 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1444 system startup.
1445
1446quiet
1447 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1448 line argument "-q".
1449
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001450
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014513.4. Userlists
1452--------------
1453It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1454http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1455it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1456
1457userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001458 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001459 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1460
1461group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001462 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001463 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1464 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1465
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001466user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1467 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1469 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001470 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1471 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001472 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001473 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001474
1475
1476 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001477 userlist L1
1478 group G1 users tiger,scott
1479 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001480
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001481 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1482 user scott insecure-password elgato
1483 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001484
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001485 userlist L2
1486 group G1
1487 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001488
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001489 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1490 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1491 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001492
1493 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001494
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001495
14963.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001497----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001498It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1499several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1500instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1501values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1502automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1503In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1504using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1505tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1506reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1507Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1508that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1509each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001510
1511peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001512 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001513 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1514
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001515disabled
1516 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1517 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1518 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1519
1520enable
1521 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1522
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001523peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1524 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1525 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1526 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1527 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1528 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1529 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1530
1531 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1532 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1533
1534 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1535 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1536 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1537 across all peers.
1538
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001539 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1540 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001541
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001542 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001543 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001544 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1545 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1546 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001547
1548 backend mybackend
1549 mode tcp
1550 balance roundrobin
1551 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1552 stick on src
1553
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001554 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1555 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001556
1557
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015583.6. Mailers
1559------------
1560It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1561If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1562in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1563
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001564mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001565 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1566 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1567
1568mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1569 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1570
1571 Example:
1572 mailers mymailers
1573 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1574 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1575
1576 backend mybackend
1577 mode tcp
1578 balance roundrobin
1579
1580 email-alert mailers mymailers
1581 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1582 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1583
1584 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1585 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1586
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001587timeout mail <time>
1588 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1589 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1590 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1591 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1592
1593 Example:
1594 mailers mymailers
1595 timeout mail 20s
1596 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015984. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001599----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001601Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001602 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603 - frontend <name>
1604 - backend <name>
1605 - listen <name>
1606
1607A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1608its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1609section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611
1612A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1613connections.
1614
1615A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1616to forward incoming connections.
1617
1618A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1619parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001621All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1622'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1623case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1624
1625Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1626logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1627proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1628However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1629name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1630
1631Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1632and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001633bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001634protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1635modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1636arbitrary criteria.
1637
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001638In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1639a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1640the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1641
1642 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1643 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1644 between responses and new requests.
1645
1646 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1647 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1648 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1649 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1650
1651 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1652 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1653 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1654
1655 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1656 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1657 client-facing connection remains open.
1658
1659 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1660 after the end of the response.
1661
1662The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1663frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1664following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1665weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1666
1667 Backend mode
1668
1669 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1670 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1671 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1672 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1673 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1674 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1675 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1676 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1677 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1678 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1679 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1680
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001681
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016834.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1684--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001686The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1687limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1688they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1689limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001690marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001692and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1693with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1694specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001695
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001696
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001697 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1698------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1699acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001700appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001701backlog X X X -
1702balance X - X X
1703bind - X X -
1704bind-process X X X X
1705block - X X X
1706capture cookie - X X -
1707capture request header - X X -
1708capture response header - X X -
1709clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001710compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001711contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1712cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001713declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001714default-server X - X X
1715default_backend X X X -
1716description - X X X
1717disabled X X X X
1718dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001719email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001720email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001721email-alert mailers X X X X
1722email-alert myhostname X X X X
1723email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001724enabled X X X X
1725errorfile X X X X
1726errorloc X X X X
1727errorloc302 X X X X
1728-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1729errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001730force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001731filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001732fullconn X - X X
1733grace X X X X
1734hash-type X - X X
1735http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001736http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001737http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001738http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001739http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001740http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001741http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001742id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001743ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001744load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001745log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001746log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001747log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001748log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001749max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001750maxconn X X X -
1751mode X X X X
1752monitor fail - X X -
1753monitor-net X X X -
1754monitor-uri X X X -
1755option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1756option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1757option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1758option allbackups (*) X - X X
1759option checkcache (*) X - X X
1760option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1761option contstats (*) X X X -
1762option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1763option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1764option forceclose (*) X X X X
1765-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1766option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001767option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001768option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001769option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001770option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001771option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001772option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001773option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001774option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1775option httpchk X - X X
1776option httpclose (*) X X X X
1777option httplog X X X X
1778option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001779option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001780option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001781option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001782option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1783option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1784option logasap (*) X X X -
1785option mysql-check X - X X
1786option nolinger (*) X X X X
1787option originalto X X X X
1788option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001789option pgsql-check X - X X
1790option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001791option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001792option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001793option smtpchk X - X X
1794option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1795option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1796option splice-request (*) X X X X
1797option splice-response (*) X X X X
1798option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1799option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1800-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001801option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001802option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1803option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1804option tcpka X X X X
1805option tcplog X X X X
1806option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001807external-check command X - X X
1808external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001809persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1810rate-limit sessions X X X -
1811redirect - X X X
1812redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1813redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1814reqadd - X X X
1815reqallow - X X X
1816reqdel - X X X
1817reqdeny - X X X
1818reqiallow - X X X
1819reqidel - X X X
1820reqideny - X X X
1821reqipass - X X X
1822reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823reqitarpit - X X X
1824reqpass - X X X
1825reqrep - X X X
1826-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827reqtarpit - X X X
1828retries X - X X
1829rspadd - X X X
1830rspdel - X X X
1831rspdeny - X X X
1832rspidel - X X X
1833rspideny - X X X
1834rspirep - X X X
1835rsprep - X X X
1836server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001837server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001838source X - X X
1839srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001840stats admin - X X X
1841stats auth X X X X
1842stats enable X X X X
1843stats hide-version X X X X
1844stats http-request - X X X
1845stats realm X X X X
1846stats refresh X X X X
1847stats scope X X X X
1848stats show-desc X X X X
1849stats show-legends X X X X
1850stats show-node X X X X
1851stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001852-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1853stick match - - X X
1854stick on - - X X
1855stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001856stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001858tcp-check connect - - X X
1859tcp-check expect - - X X
1860tcp-check send - - X X
1861tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001862tcp-request connection - X X -
1863tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001864tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001865tcp-response content - - X X
1866tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001867timeout check X - X X
1868timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001869timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001870timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1871timeout connect X - X X
1872timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1873timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1874timeout http-request X X X X
1875timeout queue X - X X
1876timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001877timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001878timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1879timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001880timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001882unique-id-format X X X -
1883unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001884use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001885use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1887 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001889
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018904.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1891---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892
1893This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1894
1895
1896acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1897 Declare or complete an access list.
1898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1899 no | yes | yes | yes
1900 Example:
1901 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1902 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1903 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1904
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001906
1907
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001908appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1909 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001910 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1912 no | no | yes | yes
1913 Arguments :
1914 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1915 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1916
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001917 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918 checked in each cookie value.
1919
1920 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1921 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1922 milliseconds.
1923
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001924 request-learn
1925 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1926 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1927 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1928 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1929 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1930 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1931
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001932 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1933 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1934 data following this prefix.
1935
1936 Example :
1937 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1938
1939 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1940 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1941
1942 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1943 2 modes are currently supported :
1944 - path-parameters :
1945 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1946 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1947 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1948 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1949 - query-string :
1950 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1951 query string.
1952
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001953 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1954 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1955 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001957 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1958 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001959
1960
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001961backlog <conns>
1962 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1964 yes | yes | yes | no
1965 Arguments :
1966 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1967 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001968 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001969
1970 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1971 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1972 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1973 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1974 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1975 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1976 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1977 backlog parameter.
1978
1979 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1980 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1981 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1982
1983 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1984
1985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001986balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001987balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001988 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1990 yes | no | yes | yes
1991 Arguments :
1992 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1993 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1994 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1995 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1996
1997 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1998 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1999 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2000 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002001 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002002 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002003 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2004 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2005 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2006 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2007 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2008 it, so that you don't worry.
2009
2010 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2011 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2012 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2013 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2014 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2015 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2016 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2017 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002018
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002019 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2020 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2021 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2022 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2023 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2024 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2025 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2026 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2027
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002028 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002029 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002030 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2031 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002032 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002033 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2034 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2035 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2036 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2037 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002038 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2039 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2040 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2041 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2042 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2043 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2046 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2047 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2048 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2049 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2050 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2051 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2052 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002053 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002055 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2056 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2057 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002058
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002059 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2060 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2061 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2062 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2063 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2064 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2065 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2066 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2067 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2068 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2069 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2070 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002072 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002073 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2074 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2075 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2076 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2077 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2078 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2079 URIs start with a leading "/".
2080
2081 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2082 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2083 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2084 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002087 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2088
2089 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002090 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2091 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002092 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2093 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2094 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2095 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002097 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2098 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002099
2100 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2101 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2102 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2103 server will receive the request.
2104
2105 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2106 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2107 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2108 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2109 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002110 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2111 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2112 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002113
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002114 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2115 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2116 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2117 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2118 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002120 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002121 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2122 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2123 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2124
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002125 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2126 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2127 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2128
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002129 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002130 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002131 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2132 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2133 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2134 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2135 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2136 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002137 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002138 used instead.
2139
2140 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2141 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2142 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2143 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2144
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002145 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2146 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2147 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2148
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002149 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002152 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2153 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002154
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002155 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2156 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2157 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158
2159 Examples :
2160 balance roundrobin
2161 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002162 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002163 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2164 balance hdr(host)
2165 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002166
2167 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2168 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2169
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002170 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002171 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2172 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2173 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2174 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2175
2176 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2177 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2178 defaults to 16 kB.
2179
2180 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2181 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2182
2183 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2184 Round Robin.
2185
2186 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2187 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2188 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2189 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2190
2191 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2192
2193 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002194 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002195 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2196 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2197 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002198
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002199 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200
2201
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002202bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2203bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002204 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2206 no | yes | yes | no
2207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002208 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2209 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2210 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2211 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002212 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002213 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2214 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2215 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2216 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2217 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2218 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2219 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002220 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2221 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2222 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2223 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2224 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2225 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2226 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002227 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2228 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2229 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002230 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2231 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2232 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002233
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002234 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2235 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002236 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2237 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2238 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002239 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2240 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2241 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2242 the range.
2243
2244 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2245 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2246 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2247 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2248 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2249 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2250 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002251 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002252 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002253
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002254 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2255 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2256 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2257 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2258 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2259 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2260 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2261 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2262
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002263 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2264 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2265 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2266 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002268 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2269 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2270 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2271 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2272 in a frontend.
2273
2274 Example :
2275 listen http_proxy
2276 bind :80,:443
2277 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002278 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002280 listen http_https_proxy
2281 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002282 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002283
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002284 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2285 bind ipv6@:80
2286 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2287 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2288
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002289 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002290 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002291
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002292 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2293 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2294 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2295 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2296 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2297
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002298 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002299 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002300
2301
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002302bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002303 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2305 yes | yes | yes | yes
2306 Arguments :
2307 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2308 may be used to override a default value.
2309
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002310 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002311 option may be combined with other numbers.
2312
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002313 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002314 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2315 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2316 missing from all processes.
2317
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002318 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002319 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002320 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2321 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2322 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2323 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002324
2325 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2326 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2327 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2328 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2329 and 'even' instances.
2330
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002331 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2332 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2333 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2334 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002335
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002336 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2337 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2338
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002339 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2340 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2341 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2342
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002343 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2344 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2345
2346 Example :
2347 listen app_ip1
2348 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002349 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002350
2351 listen app_ip2
2352 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002353 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002354
2355 listen management
2356 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002357 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002358
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002359 listen management
2360 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2361 bind-process 1-4
2362
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002363 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002364
2365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002366block { if | unless } <condition>
2367 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2369 no | yes | yes | yes
2370
2371 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2372 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002373 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002374 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2376 "block" statements per instance.
2377
2378 Example:
2379 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2380 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2381 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2382 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002384 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002385
2386
2387capture cookie <name> len <length>
2388 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2390 no | yes | yes | no
2391 Arguments :
2392 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2393 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2394 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2395 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2396 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2397
2398 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2399 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2400 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2401 right if it exceeds <length>.
2402
2403 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2404 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2405 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2406 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2407
2408 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2409 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2410 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2411
2412 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2413 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2414 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002415 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2416 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2417 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418
2419 Example:
2420 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2421
2422 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002423 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002424
2425
2426capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002427 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2429 no | yes | yes | no
2430 Arguments :
2431 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002432 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2434 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2435 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2436
2437 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2438 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2439 it exceeds <length>.
2440
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002441 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2443 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002444 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2445 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2446 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2447 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002448 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002449 environments to find where the request came from.
2450
2451 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2452 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2453 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2454 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002456 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2457 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2458 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2459 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2460 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
2462 Example:
2463 capture request header Host len 15
2464 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002465 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002467 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 about logging.
2469
2470
2471capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002472 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2474 no | yes | yes | no
2475 Arguments :
2476 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002477 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2479 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2480 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2481
2482 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2483 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2484 it exceeds <length>.
2485
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002486 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002487 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2488 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2489 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002490 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2491 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2492 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2493 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002494
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002495 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2496 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2497 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2498 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2499 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002500
2501 Example:
2502 capture response header Content-length len 9
2503 capture response header Location len 15
2504
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002505 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002506 about logging.
2507
2508
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002509clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002510 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2512 yes | yes | yes | no
2513 Arguments :
2514 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2515 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2516 as explained at the top of this document.
2517
2518 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2519 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2520 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2521 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2522 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2523 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2524 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2525 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002526 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002527 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2528 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2529
2530 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2531 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2532 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2533 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2534 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2535 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2536
2537 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2538 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2539
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002540 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2541 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002543compression algo <algorithm> ...
2544compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002545compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002546 Enable HTTP compression.
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 yes | yes | yes | yes
2549 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002550 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2551 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2552 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2553
2554 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002555 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2556 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2557 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002558
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002559 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002560 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002561
2562 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2563 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2564 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2565 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2566 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002567 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002568
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002569 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2570 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2571 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2572 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2573 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2574 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2575 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002576 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002577
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002578 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002579 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002580 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2581 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2582 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2583 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2584 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002585
2586 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2587 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2588 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2589 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2590 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002591 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2592 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2593 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2594 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2595 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002596 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2597 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002598
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002599 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002600 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2601 "Accept-Encoding" header
2602 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002603 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002604 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2605 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002606 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2607 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2608 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2609 "multipart"
2610 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2611 header
2612 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2613 and later
2614 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2615 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002616
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002617 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2618 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002619
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002620 Examples :
2621 compression algo gzip
2622 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002623
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002624
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002625contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002626 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2628 yes | no | yes | yes
2629 Arguments :
2630 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2631 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2632 as explained at the top of this document.
2633
2634 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002635 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002636 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2638 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2639 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2640 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2641
2642 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2643 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2644 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2645 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2646 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2647 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2648
2649 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2650 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2651 instead.
2652
2653 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2654 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2655
2656
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002657cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002658 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2659 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 yes | no | yes | yes
2663 Arguments :
2664 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2665 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2666 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2667 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2668 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2669 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2670 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2671 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2672 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2673
2674 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2675 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2676 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2677 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2678 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2679 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002680 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2681 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2682 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2683 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2684 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002685
2686 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002687 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002688
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002689 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002690 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2691 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2692 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2693 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2694 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2695 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2696 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2697 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2698 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2699 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700
2701 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2702 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2703 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2704 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2705 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2706 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2707 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2708 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2709 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002710 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002711 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2712 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2713 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002714
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002715 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2716 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2717 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002718 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2719 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2720 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2721 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002722 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2723 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2724 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
2726 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2727 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2728 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2729 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2730 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2731 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2732 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2733 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2734 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2735
2736 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2737 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2738 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2739 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2740 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2741 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2742 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2743 persistence cookie in the cache.
2744 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2745
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002746 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2747 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2748 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2749 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2750 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2751 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2752 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2753 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2754 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2755 they logout.
2756
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002757 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2758 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2759 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2760 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2761
2762 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2763 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2764 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2765 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2766 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2767 this attribute.
2768
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002769 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002770 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002771 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2772 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2773 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2774 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2775 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2776 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002777
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002778 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2779 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2780 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2781 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2782 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2783 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2784 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2785 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2786 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2787 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2788 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2789 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2790 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2791 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2792 the site.
2793
2794 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2795 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2796 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2797 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2798 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2799 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2800 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2801 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2802 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2803 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2804 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2805 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2806 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2807 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2808 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2809 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002811 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2812 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2813 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2814 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 Examples :
2817 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2818 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2819 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002820 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002822 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002824
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002825declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2826 Declares a capture slot.
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 no | yes | yes | no
2829 Arguments:
2830 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2831
2832 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2833 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2834 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2835 for use in the response.
2836
2837 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002838 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002839 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2840
2841
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002842default-server [param*]
2843 Change default options for a server in a backend
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | no | yes | yes
2846 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002847 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2848 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2849 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2850 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002851
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002852 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002853 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2854
2855 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002858default_backend <backend>
2859 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2861 yes | yes | yes | no
2862 Arguments :
2863 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2864
2865 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2866 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2867 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2868 will catch all undetermined requests.
2869
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870 Example :
2871
2872 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2873 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2874 default_backend dynamic
2875
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002876 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002878
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002879description <string>
2880 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2882 no | yes | yes | yes
2883 Arguments : string
2884
2885 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2886 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2887 it describes.
2888 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2889
2890
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002891disabled
2892 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2894 yes | yes | yes | yes
2895 Arguments : none
2896
2897 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2898 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2899 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2900 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2901 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2902 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2903 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2904
2905 See also : "enabled"
2906
2907
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002908dispatch <address>:<port>
2909 Set a default server address
2910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2911 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002913
2914 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2915 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2916 during start-up.
2917
2918 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2919 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2920 possible with normal servers.
2921
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002922 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002923 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2924 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2925 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2926 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2927
2928 See also : "server"
2929
2930
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002931enabled
2932 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | yes
2935 Arguments : none
2936
2937 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2938 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2939
2940 See also : "disabled"
2941
2942
2943errorfile <code> <file>
2944 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2946 yes | yes | yes | yes
2947 Arguments :
2948 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002949 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2950 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002951
2952 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002953 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002954 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002955 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2956 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002957
2958 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2959 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2960 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2961
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002962 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2963
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002964 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2965 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2966 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2967 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2968
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002969 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2970 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2971 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2972 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2973 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2974 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002976 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2977 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2978 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002979 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002980 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2981
2982 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2983
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002984 Example :
2985 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002986 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002987 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2988 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002990
2991errorloc <code> <url>
2992errorloc302 <code> <url>
2993 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2995 yes | yes | yes | yes
2996 Arguments :
2997 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002998 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002999
3000 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3001 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3002 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3003 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3004 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3005
3006 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3007 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3008 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3009
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003010 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3011
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003012 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3013 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3014 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3015 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003016 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003017 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3018 request.
3019
3020 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3021
3022
3023errorloc303 <code> <url>
3024 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3026 yes | yes | yes | yes
3027 Arguments :
3028 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3029 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3030
3031 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3032 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3033 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3034 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3035 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3036
3037 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3038 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3039 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3040
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003041 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3042
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003043 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3044 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3045 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3046 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003047 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003048
3049 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3050
3051
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003052email-alert from <emailaddr>
3053 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3054 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 yes | yes | yes | yes
3057
3058 Arguments :
3059
3060 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3061
3062 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3063 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3064
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003065 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003066 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3067 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003068
3069
3070email-alert level <level>
3071 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3072 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3074 yes | yes | yes | yes
3075
3076 Arguments :
3077
3078 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3079 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3080 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3081
3082 By default level is alert
3083
3084 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3085 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3086 for the proxy.
3087
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003088 Alerts are sent when :
3089
3090 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3091 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3092 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3093 is notice or lower
3094 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3095 and a health check status update occurs
3096
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003097 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3098 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003099 section 3.6 about mailers.
3100
3101
3102email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3103 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3104 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3105 yes | yes | yes | yes
3106
3107 Arguments :
3108
3109 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3110
3111 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3112 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3113
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003114 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3115 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003116
3117
3118email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3119 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3120 mailers.
3121 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3122 yes | yes | yes | yes
3123
3124 Arguments :
3125
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003126 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003127
3128 By default the systems hostname is used.
3129
3130 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3131 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3132 for the proxy.
3133
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003134 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3135 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003136
3137
3138email-alert to <emailaddr>
3139 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3140 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3141 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3142 yes | yes | yes | yes
3143
3144 Arguments :
3145
3146 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3147
3148 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3149 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3150
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003151 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003152 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3153
3154
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003155force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3156 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3157 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3158 no | yes | yes | yes
3159
3160 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3161 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3162 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3163 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3164 marked down for maintenance operations.
3165
3166 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3167 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3168 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3169 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3170 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3171 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3172 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3173 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3174 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3175
3176 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3177 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3178 is used.
3179
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003180 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003181 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003182
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003183
3184filter <name> [param*]
3185 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 no | yes | yes | yes
3188 Arguments :
3189 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3190 referenced in section 9.
3191
3192 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3193 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3194 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3195 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3196
3197 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3198 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3199
3200 Example:
3201 listen
3202 bind *:80
3203
3204 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3205 filter compression
3206 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3207
3208 compression algo gzip
3209 compression offload
3210
3211 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3212
3213 See also : section 9.
3214
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003215
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003216fullconn <conns>
3217 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3219 yes | no | yes | yes
3220 Arguments :
3221 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3222 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3223
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003224 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003225 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003226 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003227 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3228 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3229 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3230 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3231 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003232 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003233
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003234 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3235 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003236 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3237 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3238 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003239
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003240 Example :
3241 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3242 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3243 # connections.
3244 backend dynamic
3245 fullconn 10000
3246 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3247 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3248
3249 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3250
3251
3252grace <time>
3253 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003255 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003256 Arguments :
3257 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3258 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3259 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3260
3261 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3262 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003263 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003264 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3265
3266 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3267 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3268 simplify it.
3269
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003270
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003271hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003272 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3274 yes | no | yes | yes
3275 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003276 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3277 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003278
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003279 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3280 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3281 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3282 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3283 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3284 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3285 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3286 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3287 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3288 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003289
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003290 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3291 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3292 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3293 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3294 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3295 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3296 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3297 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3298 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3299 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3300 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3301 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3302 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003303 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3304 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003305
3306 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3307
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003308 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003309 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3310 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3311 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003312 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3313 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3314 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003315
3316 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3317 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003318 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3319 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3320 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3321 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3322
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003323 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3324 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3325 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3326 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3327 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3328 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3329 parameter.
3330
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003331 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3332 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3333 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3334 used on strings.
3335
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003336 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3337
3338 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3339 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3340 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3341 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3342 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3343 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3344 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3345 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3346 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3347 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3348 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3349 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003350
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003351 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3352 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3353 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003354
3355 See also : "balance", "server"
3356
3357
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358http-check disable-on-404
3359 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003361 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362 Arguments : none
3363
3364 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3365 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3366 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3367 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3368 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3369 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3370 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3371 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003372 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3373 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3374 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3375
3376 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3377
3378
3379http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003380 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003382 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003383 Arguments :
3384 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3385 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003386 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003387 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3388 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3389 details on the supported keywords.
3390
3391 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3392 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3393 with the usual backslash ('\').
3394
3395 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3396 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3397 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3398 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3399 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3400
3401 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003402 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003403 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3404 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3405 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3406
3407 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003408 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003409 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3410 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3411 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3412 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3413
3414 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003415 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003416 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3417 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3418 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3419 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3420 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3421 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3422 trace).
3423
3424 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003425 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003426 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3427 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3428 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3429 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3430 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3431 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3432
3433 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3434 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3435 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3436 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3437 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3438 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3439 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3440 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3441
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003442 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3443 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3444 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3445
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003446 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3447 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3448
3449 Examples :
3450 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003451 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003452
3453 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003454 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003455
3456 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003457 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003458
3459 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003460 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003462 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003463
3464
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003465http-check send-state
3466 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3468 yes | no | yes | yes
3469 Arguments : none
3470
3471 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3472 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3473 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3474 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3475 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3476
3477 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3478 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3479 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3480 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3481 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003482 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3483 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3484 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3485
3486 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3487 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3488 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3489
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003490 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3491 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3492 checked in multiple backends.
3493
3494 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3495 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3496
3497 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3498 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3499 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3500 one fails.
3501
3502 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3503 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3504 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3505
3506 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3507 server's queue.
3508
3509 Example of a header received by the application server :
3510 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3511 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3512
3513 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3514
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003515http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003516 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003517 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003518 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003519 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3520 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003521 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3522 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003523 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3524 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3525 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003526 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003527 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003528 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003529 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003530 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003531 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003532 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003533 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003534 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3535
3536 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3537 no | yes | yes | yes
3538
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003539 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3540 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3541 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3542 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3543 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003544
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003545 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3546 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3547 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3548
3549 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3550 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
3551 are evaluated.
3552
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003553 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3554 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3555 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3556 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3557 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3558 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3559 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3560 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3561 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003562 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003563 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3564 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003565
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003566 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3567 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3568 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3569 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3570 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3571
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003572 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3573 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3574 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003575 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3576 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003577
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003578 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3579 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3580 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3581 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3582 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3583 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3584 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3585 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3586
3587 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3588 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3589 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003590 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3591 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003592
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003593 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3594 <name>.
3595
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003596 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3597 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3598 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3599 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3600 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3601 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3602 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3603 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3604
3605 Example:
3606
3607 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3608
3609 applied to:
3610
3611 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3612
3613 outputs:
3614
3615 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3616
3617 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3618
3619 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3620 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3621 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3622 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3623 header.
3624
3625 Example:
3626
3627 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3628
3629 applied to:
3630
3631 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3632
3633 outputs:
3634
3635 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3636
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003637 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3638 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3639 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3640 it.
3641
3642 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3643 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3644 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3645 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3646 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3647 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3648
3649 Example :
3650 # prepend the host name before the path
3651 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3652
3653 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3654 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3655 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3656 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3657 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3658 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3659 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3660 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3661
3662 Example :
3663 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3664 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3665
3666 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3667 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3668 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3669 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3670 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3671 "set-query".
3672
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003673 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3674 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3675 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3676 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3677 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3678 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3679 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3680 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3681
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003682 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3683 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3684 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3685 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3686 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3687 another equipment.
3688
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003689 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3690 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3691 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3692 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3693 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3694 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3695 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3696 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3697
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003698 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3699 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3700 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3701 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3702 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3703 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3704 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3705 admin privileges.
3706
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003707 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3708 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3709 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3710 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3711 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3712 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3713 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3714 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3715
3716 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3717 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3718 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3719 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3720 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3721 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3722
3723 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3724 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3725 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3726 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3727 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3728 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3729
3730 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3731 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3732 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3733 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3734 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3735 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3736 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3737 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3738 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3739
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003740 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003741 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3742 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3743 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3744 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3745 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3746 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3747 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3748 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3749 request header" for more information.
3750
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003751 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3752 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3753 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3754 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003755 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3756 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003757
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003758 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3759 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3760 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3761 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3762 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3763 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3764 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3765 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3766 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3767 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3768 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3769 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3770
3771 These actions take one or two arguments :
3772 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3773 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3774 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3775 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3776
3777 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3778 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3779 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3780 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3781
3782 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3783 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3784 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3785 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3786 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3787 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3788 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3789 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3790
3791 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3792 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3793 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3794 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3795 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3796
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003797 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3798 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3799 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3800 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3801 continues.
3802
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003803 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3804 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3805 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3806 the actions evaluation continues.
3807
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003808 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3809 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3810 inline.
3811
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003812 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3813 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3814 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3815 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003816 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003817 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003818 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003819 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3820 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003821 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003822 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003823 and '_'.
3824
3825 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3826 followed by some converters.
3827
3828 Example:
3829
3830 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3831
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003832 - set-src <expr> :
3833 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3834 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3835 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3836 source IP for privacy.
3837
3838 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3839 followed by some converters.
3840
3841 Example:
3842
3843 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3844 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3845
3846 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3847
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003848 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3849 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3850 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3851 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3852 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3853 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3854 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3855 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3856 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3857 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3858 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3859 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3860 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3861 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3862 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3863 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3864
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003865 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3866
3867 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3868 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003869 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3870 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3871
3872 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3873 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3874 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3875 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003876
3877 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003878 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3879 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3880 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003881
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003882 http-request allow if nagios
3883 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3884 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3885 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003886
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003887 Example:
3888 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003889 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003890
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003891 Example:
3892 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3893 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003894 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003895 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3896 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3897 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3898 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3899 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3900 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3901
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003902 Example:
3903 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3904 acl add path /addacl
3905 acl del path /delacl
3906
3907 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3908
3909 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3910 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3911
3912 Example:
3913 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3914 acl setmap path /setmap
3915 acl delmap path /delmap
3916
3917 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3918
3919 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3920 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3921
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003922 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3923 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003924
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003925http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003926 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003927 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003928 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3929 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003930 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003931 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3932 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3933 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3934 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003935 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003936 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003937 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003938 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003939 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003940 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003941 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003942 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3943
3944 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3945 no | yes | yes | yes
3946
3947 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3948 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3949 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3950 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3951 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3952 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3953
3954 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3955 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3956 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3957 current section.
3958
3959 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3960 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3961 rules are evaluated.
3962
3963 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3964 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3965 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3966 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3967 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3968 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3969 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3970
3971 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3972 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3973 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3974 external users.
3975
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003976 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3977 <name>.
3978
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003979 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3980 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3981 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3982 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3983 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3984 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3985 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3986 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3987
3988 Example:
3989
3990 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3991
3992 applied to:
3993
3994 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3995
3996 outputs:
3997
3998 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3999
4000 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4001
4002 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4003 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4004 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4005 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4006 header.
4007
4008 Example:
4009
4010 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4011
4012 applied to:
4013
4014 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4015
4016 outputs:
4017
4018 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4019
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004020 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4021 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4022 adapted to the new code.
4023
4024 Example:
4025
4026 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4027 http-response set-status 431
4028
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004029 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4030 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4031 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4032 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4033 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4034 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4035 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4036 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4037
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004038 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4039 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4040 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4041 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4042 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4043 another equipment.
4044
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004045 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4046 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4047 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4048 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4049 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4050 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4051 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4052 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4053
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004054 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4055 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4056 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4057 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4058 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4059 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4060 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4061 admin privileges.
4062
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004063 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4064 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4065 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4066 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4067 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4068 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4069 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4070 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4071
4072 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4073 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4074 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4075 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4076 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4077 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4078
4079 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4080 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4081 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4082 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4083 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4084 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4085
4086 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4087 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4088 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4089 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4090 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4091 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4092 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4093 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4094 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4095
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004096 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4097 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4098 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4099 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4100 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4101 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4102 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4103 response header" for more information.
4104
4105 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4106 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4107 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4108 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4109 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004110 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4111 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004112
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004113 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4114 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4115 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4116 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4117 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4118 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4119
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004120 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4121 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4122 inline.
4123
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004124 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4125 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4126 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4127 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004128 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004129 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004130 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004131 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4132 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004133 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004134 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004135 and '_'.
4136
4137 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4138 followed by some converters.
4139
4140 Example:
4141
4142 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4143
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004144 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4145 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4146 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4147 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4148 continues.
4149
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004150 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4151 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4152 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4153 the actions evaluation continues.
4154
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004155 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4156 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4157 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4158 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4159 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4160 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4161 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4162 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4163 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4164 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4165 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4166 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4167 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4168 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4169 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4170 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4171
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004172 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4173
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004174 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004175 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4176 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004177 rules.
4178
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004179 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4180 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4181 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4182 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4183
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004184 Example:
4185 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4186
4187 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4188
4189 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4190 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4191
4192 Example:
4193 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4194
4195 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4196
4197 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4198 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4199
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004200 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4201 ACL usage.
4202
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004203
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004204http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4205 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4206
4207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4208 yes | no | yes | yes
4209
4210 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4211 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4212 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4213 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4214 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4215 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4216
4217 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4218
4219 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4220 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4221 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4222 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4223 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4224 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4225 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4226 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4227 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4228 not checking any request past the first one.
4229
4230 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4231 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4232 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4233 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4234 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4235 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4236 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4237
4238 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4239 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4240 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4241 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4242 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4243 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4244 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4245 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4246 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4247 downsides of rare connection failures.
4248
4249 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4250 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4251 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4252 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4253 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4254 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4255 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4256 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4257 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4258 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4259 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4260 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4261
4262 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4263 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4264 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4265 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4266
4267 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4268 and are never shared ;
4269
4270 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4271 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4272 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4273 and are never shared ;
4274
4275 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4276 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4277 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4278
4279 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4280 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4281 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4282
4283 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4284
4285
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004286http-send-name-header [<header>]
4287 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4288
4289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4290 yes | no | yes | yes
4291
4292 Arguments :
4293
4294 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4295
4296 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4297 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4298 is added with the header string proved.
4299
4300 See also : "server"
4301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004302id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004303 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4305 no | yes | yes | yes
4306 Arguments : none
4307
4308 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4309 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4310 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004311
4312
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004313ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4314 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4315 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4316 no | yes | yes | yes
4317
4318 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4319 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4320 and running).
4321
4322 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4323 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4324 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004325 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004326 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4327
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004328 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4329 "unless" condition is met.
4330
4331 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4332
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004333load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4334 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4336 yes | no | yes | yes
4337
4338 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4339 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4340 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4341 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4342 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4343 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4344 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4345 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4346
4347 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4348 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004349 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004350
4351 Arguments:
4352 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4353 named "server-state-file".
4354
4355 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4356 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4357 name is used as a file name.
4358
4359 none don't load any stat for this backend
4360
4361 Notes:
4362 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4363 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4364 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4365
4366 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4367 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4368
4369 Example 1:
4370
4371 Minimal configuration:
4372
4373 global
4374 stats socket /tmp/socket
4375 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
4376
4377 defaults
4378 load-server-state-from-file global
4379
4380 backend bk
4381 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4382 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4383
4384 Then one can run :
4385
4386 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4387
4388 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4389
4390 1
4391 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4392 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4393 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4394
4395 Example 2:
4396
4397 Minimal configuration:
4398
4399 global
4400 stats socket /tmp/socket
4401 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4402
4403 defaults
4404 load-server-state-from-file local
4405
4406 backend bk
4407 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4408 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4409
4410 Then one can run :
4411
4412 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4413
4414 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4415
4416 1
4417 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4418 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4419 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4420
4421 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4422 "show servers state"
4423
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004424
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004425log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004426log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004427no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004428 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4430 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004431
4432 Prefix :
4433 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4434 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4435 prefix does not allow arguments.
4436
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004437 Arguments :
4438 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4439 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4440 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4441 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4442 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4443 parameter.
4444
4445 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4446 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4447
4448 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4449 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4450 standard syslog port).
4451
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004452 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4453 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4454 standard syslog port).
4455
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004456 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4457 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4458 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4459 appropriately writeable).
4460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004461 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4462 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004463
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004464 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4465 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4466 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4467 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4468 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4469 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4470 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4471 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4472 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4473 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4474 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4475
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004476 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4477
4478 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4479 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4480 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4481
4482 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4483 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4484 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004485 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4486 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4487 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4488 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4489 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004490
4491 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4492
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004493 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4494 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4495 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004496
4497 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4498 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4499 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4500 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4501
4502 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4503 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004504
4505 Example :
4506 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004507 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4508 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004509 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004511
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004512log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004513 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4515 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004516
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004517 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4518 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4519 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4520 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4521 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004522
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004523log-format-sd <string>
4524 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4526 yes | yes | yes | no
4527
4528 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4529 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4530 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4531 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4532 which covers the log format string in depth.
4533
4534 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4535 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4536
4537 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4538 log format to "rfc5424".
4539
4540 Example :
4541 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4542
4543
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004544log-tag <string>
4545 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4546 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4547 yes | yes | yes | yes
4548
4549 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4550 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4551 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4552 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4553 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4554 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4555 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4556 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4557 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004558
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004559max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4560 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 yes | no | yes | yes
4563
4564 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4565 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4566 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4567 servers.
4568
4569 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4570 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4571 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4572 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4573 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4574 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4575 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4576 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4577 picking a different server.
4578
4579 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4580 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4581 even if they have to be queued.
4582
4583 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4584 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4585
4586
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004587maxconn <conns>
4588 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4590 yes | yes | yes | no
4591 Arguments :
4592 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4593 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4594 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4595 closes.
4596
4597 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4598 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4599 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4600 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004601 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4602 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4603 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4604 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004605
4606 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4607 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4608 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4609
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004610 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4611
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004612 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4613
4614
4615mode { tcp|http|health }
4616 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4618 yes | yes | yes | yes
4619 Arguments :
4620 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4621 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4622 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4623 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4624
4625 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4626 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4627 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4628 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4629 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4630
4631 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004632 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4633 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4634 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4635 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4636 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4637 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4638 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004639
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004640 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4641 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4642 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004643
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004644 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004645 defaults http_instances
4646 mode http
4647
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004648 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004650
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004651monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004652 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4654 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004655 Arguments :
4656 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4657 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004658 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004659 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4660 backend and its backup.
4661
4662 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4663 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4664 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4665 servers in a list of backends.
4666
4667 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4668 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4669 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4670 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4671 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4672 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4673 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004674 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4675 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004676
4677 Example:
4678 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004679 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004680 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4681 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4682 monitor-uri /site_alive
4683 monitor fail if site_dead
4684
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004685 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004686
4687
4688monitor-net <source>
4689 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4691 yes | yes | yes | no
4692 Arguments :
4693 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4694 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4695 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4696 followed by a mask.
4697
4698 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4699 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004700 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004701 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4702
4703 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4704 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4705 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4706 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004707 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4708 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4709 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004710
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004711 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4712 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4713 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4714 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4715 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4716 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004717
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004718 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4719 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004720
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004721 Example :
4722 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4723 frontend www
4724 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4725
4726 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4727
4728
4729monitor-uri <uri>
4730 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4732 yes | yes | yes | no
4733 Arguments :
4734 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4735 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4736
4737 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4738 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4739 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4740 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4741 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4742 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4743 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4744 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4745
4746 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4747 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4748 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4749 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4750 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4751 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4752
4753 Example :
4754 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4755 frontend www
4756 mode http
4757 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4758
4759 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4760
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004761
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004762option abortonclose
4763no option abortonclose
4764 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4766 yes | no | yes | yes
4767 Arguments : none
4768
4769 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4770 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4771 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4772 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004773 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004774 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4775 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4776 encountered while delivering the response.
4777
4778 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4779 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4780 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4781 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4782 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4783 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004784 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004785 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004786 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004787 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4788 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4789 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4790
4791 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4792 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4793 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4794 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4795 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4796 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4797 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4798 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004799 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004800
4801 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4802 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4803
4804 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4805
4806
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004807option accept-invalid-http-request
4808no option accept-invalid-http-request
4809 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | yes | yes | no
4812 Arguments : none
4813
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004814 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004815 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4816 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4817 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4818 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4819 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4820 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4821 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004822 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4823 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4824 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4825 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4826 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004827 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004828 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4829 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4830 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004831
4832 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4833 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4834 been confirmed.
4835
4836 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4837 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004838 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4839 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004840 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4841
4842 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4843 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4844
4845 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4846 stats socket.
4847
4848
4849option accept-invalid-http-response
4850no option accept-invalid-http-response
4851 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4853 yes | no | yes | yes
4854 Arguments : none
4855
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004856 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004857 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4858 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4859 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4860 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4861 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4862 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4863 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004864 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4865 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4866 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004867
4868 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4869 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4870 been confirmed.
4871
4872 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4873 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4874 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4875 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4876
4877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4879
4880 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4881 stats socket.
4882
4883
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004884option allbackups
4885no option allbackups
4886 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | no | yes | yes
4889 Arguments : none
4890
4891 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4892 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4893 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4894 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4895 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4896 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4897 order between the backup servers anymore.
4898
4899 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4900 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4901
4902 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4903 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4904
4905
4906option checkcache
4907no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004908 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4910 yes | no | yes | yes
4911 Arguments : none
4912
4913 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4914 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004915 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004916 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4917 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004918 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004919
4920 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004921 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004922 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004923 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4924 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004925 to the client are :
4926 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004927 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004928 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004929 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4930 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4931 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4932 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4933 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4934 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4935 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4936 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4937 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4938 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4939 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4940
4941 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004942 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004943 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004944 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004945 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
4946
4947 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
4948 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004949 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004950 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
4951
4952 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4953 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4954
4955
4956option clitcpka
4957no option clitcpka
4958 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
4959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4960 yes | yes | yes | no
4961 Arguments : none
4962
4963 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4964 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4965 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4966 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4967
4968 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4969 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4970 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4971 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4972
4973 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4974 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4975 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4976 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4977 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4978
4979 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4980
4981 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4982 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4983 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4984
4985 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4986 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4987
4988 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4989
4990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004991option contstats
4992 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4994 yes | yes | yes | no
4995 Arguments : none
4996
4997 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4998 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4999 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5000 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5001 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5002 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5003 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5004
5005
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005006option dontlog-normal
5007no option dontlog-normal
5008 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5010 yes | yes | yes | no
5011 Arguments : none
5012
5013 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5014 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5015 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5016 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5017 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5018 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5019 logged.
5020
5021 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5022 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5023 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005025 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005026 logging.
5027
5028
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005029option dontlognull
5030no option dontlognull
5031 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 yes | yes | yes | no
5034 Arguments : none
5035
5036 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5037 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5038 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5039 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5040 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5041 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005042 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5043 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5044 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005045
5046 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5047 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5048 would not be logged.
5049
5050 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5051 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5052
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005053 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5054 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005055
5056
5057option forceclose
5058no option forceclose
5059 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005061 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005062 Arguments : none
5063
5064 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5065 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5066 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5067 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5068 global session times in the logs.
5069
5070 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005071 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005072 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005073
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005074 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5075 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5076 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5077
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005078 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5079 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005080
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005081 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5082 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5083
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005084 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005085
5086
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005087option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005088 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5090 yes | yes | yes | yes
5091 Arguments :
5092 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5093 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005094 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005095 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005096
5097 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5098 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5099 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5100 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5101 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5102 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5103 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005104 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5105 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5106 possible that the client has already brought one.
5107
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005108 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005109 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005110 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5111 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005112 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5113 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005114
5115 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5116 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5117 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5118 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5119 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5120 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5121 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5122
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005123 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5124 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5125 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5126 are under the control of the end-user.
5127
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005128 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005129 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5130 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005131 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5132 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5133 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005134
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005135 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005136 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5137 frontend www
5138 mode http
5139 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5140
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005141 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5142 backend www
5143 mode http
5144 option forwardfor header X-Client
5145
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005146 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005147 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005148
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005149
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005150option http-buffer-request
5151no option http-buffer-request
5152 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5154 yes | yes | yes | yes
5155 Arguments : none
5156
5157 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5158 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5159 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5160 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5161 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5162 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5163 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5164 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5165 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5166 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5167 default.
5168
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005169 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005170
5171
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005172option http-ignore-probes
5173no option http-ignore-probes
5174 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5176 yes | yes | yes | no
5177 Arguments : none
5178
5179 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5180 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5181 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5182 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5183 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5184 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5185 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5186 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5187 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5188 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5189 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5190 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5191
5192 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5193 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5194 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5195 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5196 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5197 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5198 are often the only way to detect them.
5199
5200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5202
5203 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5204
5205
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005206option http-keep-alive
5207no option http-keep-alive
5208 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5210 yes | yes | yes | yes
5211 Arguments : none
5212
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005213 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5214 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5215 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5216 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5217 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5218 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5219 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5220
5221 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5222 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005223 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5224 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5225 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5226 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5227 situations where this option may be useful :
5228
5229 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5230 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5231
5232 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5233 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5234
5235 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5236 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5237 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5238 request.
5239
5240 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5241 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005242 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5243 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5244 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005245
5246 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5247 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5248
5249 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5250 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5251 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5252 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5253 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5254 not set.
5255
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005256 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5257 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005258 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005259 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005260
5261 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005262 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5263 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005264
5265
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005266option http-no-delay
5267no option http-no-delay
5268 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5270 yes | yes | yes | yes
5271 Arguments : none
5272
5273 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5274 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5275 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5276 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5277 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5278 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5279 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5280 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5281 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5282 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5283 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5284 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5285 affected.
5286
5287 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5288 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5289 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5290 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5291 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5292 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5293 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5294 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5295 latency environments.
5296
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005297 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5298
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005299
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005300option http-pretend-keepalive
5301no option http-pretend-keepalive
5302 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | yes | yes | yes
5305 Arguments : none
5306
5307 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5308 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5309 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5310 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5311 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5312 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5313 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5314 consider the response complete.
5315
5316 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5317 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5318 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5319 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5320 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5321 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5322
5323 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5324 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5325 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5326 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5327 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5328 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5329 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5330
5331 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5332 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005333 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005334 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5335 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005336
5337 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5338 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5339
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005340 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5341 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005342
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005343
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005344option http-server-close
5345no option http-server-close
5346 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5348 yes | yes | yes | yes
5349 Arguments : none
5350
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005351 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5352 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5353 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5354 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5355 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5356 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5357 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5358 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5359 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5360 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5361 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5362 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5363 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5364 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5365 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5366 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005367
5368 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5369 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5370 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5371 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005372 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5373 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005374
5375 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5376 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005377 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5378 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005379 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5380 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005381
5382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5384
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005385 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005386 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5387 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005388
5389
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005390option http-tunnel
5391no option http-tunnel
5392 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5394 yes | yes | yes | yes
5395 Arguments : none
5396
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005397 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5398 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5399 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5400 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5401 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5402 "option http-tunnel".
5403
5404 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005405 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005406 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5407 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5408 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5409 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5410 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5411 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5412 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005413
5414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5416
5417 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5418 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5419 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5420
5421
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005422option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005423no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005424 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5426 yes | yes | yes | no
5427 Arguments : none
5428
5429 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5430 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5431 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5432 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5433 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5434 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5435 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5436
5437 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5438 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005439 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5440 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5441 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005442
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005443 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5444 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5445 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5446 front of an existing proxy.
5447
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005448 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5449
5450 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5451 http-server-close".
5452
5453
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005454option httpchk
5455option httpchk <uri>
5456option httpchk <method> <uri>
5457option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5458 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | no | yes | yes
5461 Arguments :
5462 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5463 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5464 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5465 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5466 ones.
5467
5468 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5469 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5470 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5471
5472 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5473 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5474 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5475 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5476 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5477
5478 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5479 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5480 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5481 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5482 the lack of any response.
5483
5484 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5485
5486 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5487 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5488 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5489
5490 Examples :
5491 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5492 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5493 backend https_relay
5494 mode tcp
5495 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5496 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5497
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005498 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5499 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5500 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005501
5502
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005503option httpclose
5504no option httpclose
5505 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5507 yes | yes | yes | yes
5508 Arguments : none
5509
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005510 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5511 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5512 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5513 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005514 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005515 "option http-tunnel".
5516
5517 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5518 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5519 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5520 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5521 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5522 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5523 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5524 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005525
5526 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005527 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005528 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5529 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5530 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5531 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5532 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005533
5534 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5535 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005536 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5537 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005538 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5539 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005540
5541 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5542 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5543
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005544 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5545 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005546
5547
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005548option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005549 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5551 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005552 Arguments :
5553 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5554 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5555 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5556 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5557 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005558
5559 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5560 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5561 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5562 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5563 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5564 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5565 ports.
5566
5567 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5568
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005569 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5570 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005572 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005573
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005574
5575option http_proxy
5576no option http_proxy
5577 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5579 yes | yes | yes | yes
5580 Arguments : none
5581
5582 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5583 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5584 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5585 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5586 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5587
5588 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5589 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005590 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5591 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005592
5593 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5594 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5595
5596 Example :
5597 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5598 backend direct_forward
5599 option httpclose
5600 option http_proxy
5601
5602 See also : "option httpclose"
5603
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005604
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005605option independent-streams
5606no option independent-streams
5607 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5609 yes | yes | yes | yes
5610 Arguments : none
5611
5612 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5613 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5614 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5615 receive data or not.
5616
5617 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5618 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5619 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5620 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5621 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5622 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5623 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5624 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5625 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5626 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5627 socket buffers.
5628
5629 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5630 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5631 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5632 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5633 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5634
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005635 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005636 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5637 deprecated.
5638
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005639 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005640
5641
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005642option ldap-check
5643 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5645 yes | no | yes | yes
5646 Arguments : none
5647
5648 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5649 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5650 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5651 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5652
5653 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5654 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5655
5656 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5657 configure it.
5658
5659 Example :
5660 option ldap-check
5661
5662 See also : "option httpchk"
5663
5664
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005665option external-check
5666 Use external processes for server health checks
5667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5668 yes | no | yes | yes
5669
5670 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5671 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5672 command".
5673
5674 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5675
5676 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5677
5678
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005679option log-health-checks
5680no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005681 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5683 yes | no | yes | yes
5684 Arguments : none
5685
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005686 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5687 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5688 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005689
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005690 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5691 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5692 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5693 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5694 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5695
5696 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5697 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005698
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005699 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5700 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5701 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005702
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005703
5704option log-separate-errors
5705no option log-separate-errors
5706 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 yes | yes | yes | no
5709 Arguments : none
5710
5711 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5712 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5713 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5714 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5715 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5716 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5717 provides very important information.
5718
5719 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5720 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5721 error logs.
5722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005723 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005724 logging.
5725
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005726
5727option logasap
5728no option logasap
5729 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5731 yes | yes | yes | no
5732 Arguments : none
5733
5734 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5735 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5736 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5737 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5738 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5739 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5740 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005741 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005742 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5743 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5744
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005745 Examples :
5746 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5747 mode http
5748 option httplog
5749 option logasap
5750 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5751
5752 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5753 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5754 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5755 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005757 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005758 logging.
5759
5760
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005761option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005762 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5764 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005765 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005766 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5767 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005768 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005769
5770 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5771 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5772 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5773 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5774 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5775 in the MySQL table, like this :
5776
5777 USE mysql;
5778 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5779 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5780
5781 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5782 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5783 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5784 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5785 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5786 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5787 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5788 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5789 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5790
5791 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5792 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005793
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005794 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005795
5796 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5797 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5798 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5799 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005800 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5801 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005802
5803 See also: "option httpchk"
5804
5805
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005806option nolinger
5807no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005808 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005811 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005812
5813 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5814 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5815 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5816 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5817 connections.
5818
5819 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5820 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5821 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5822 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5823 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5824 this too.
5825
5826 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5827 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5828 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5829
5830 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5831 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5832 for servers.
5833
5834 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5835 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5836
5837
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005838option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5839 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5841 yes | yes | yes | yes
5842 Arguments :
5843 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5844 matching <network>
5845 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5846 header name.
5847
5848 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5849 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5850 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5851 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5852 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5853 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5854 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5855 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5856 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5857 possible that the client has already brought one.
5858
5859 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5860 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5861 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5862 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5863 header and requires different one.
5864
5865 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5866 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5867 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5868 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5869 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5870 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5871 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5872
5873 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5874 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5875 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5876 both are defined.
5877
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005878 Examples :
5879 # Original Destination address
5880 frontend www
5881 mode http
5882 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5883
5884 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5885 backend www
5886 mode http
5887 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5888
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005889 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5890 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005891
5892
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005893option persist
5894no option persist
5895 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5897 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005898 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005899
5900 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5901 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5902 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5903 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5904 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5905 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5906 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5907 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5908 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5909 redirected to another valid server.
5910
5911 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5912 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5913
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005914 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005915
5916
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005917option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5918 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5920 yes | no | yes | yes
5921 Arguments :
5922 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5923 PostgreSQL server.
5924
5925 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5926 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5927 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5928 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5929
5930 See also: "option httpchk"
5931
5932
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005933option prefer-last-server
5934no option prefer-last-server
5935 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5937 yes | no | yes | yes
5938 Arguments : none
5939
5940 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5941 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
5942 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
5943 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
5944 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
5945 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
5946 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
5947 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
5948 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01005949 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
5950 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
5951 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
5952 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
5953 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
5954 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
5955 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005956
5957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5959
5960 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
5961
5962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005963option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005964option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005965no option redispatch
5966 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5967 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5968 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005969 Arguments :
5970 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
5971 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
5972 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
5973 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
5974 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
5975 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
5976 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
5977 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
5978 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
5979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005980
5981 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5982 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5983 be able to access the service anymore.
5984
5985 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
5986 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
5987
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07005988 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005989 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5990 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005992 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
5993 "redisp" keywords.
5994
5995 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5996 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5997
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005998 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005999
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006000
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006001option redis-check
6002 Use redis health checks for server testing
6003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6004 yes | no | yes | yes
6005 Arguments : none
6006
6007 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6008 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6009 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6010 find the "+PONG" response message.
6011
6012 Example :
6013 option redis-check
6014
6015 See also : "option httpchk"
6016
6017
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006018option smtpchk
6019option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6020 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6022 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006023 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006024 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6025 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6026 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6027
6028 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6029 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6030 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6031
6032 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6033 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6034 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6035 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6036 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6037 dead server.
6038
6039 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6040 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6041 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6042 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6043
6044 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6045 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6046 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6047 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006048 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006049
6050 Example :
6051 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6052
6053 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6054
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006056option socket-stats
6057no option socket-stats
6058
6059 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6061 yes | yes | yes | no
6062
6063 Arguments : none
6064
6065
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006066option splice-auto
6067no option splice-auto
6068 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6070 yes | yes | yes | yes
6071 Arguments : none
6072
6073 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6074 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6075 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6076 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006077 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006078 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6079 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6080 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6081 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6082
6083 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6084 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6085 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6086 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6087 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6088 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6089 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6090 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6091 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6092 keyword.
6093
6094 Example :
6095 option splice-auto
6096
6097 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6098 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6099
6100 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6101 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6102
6103
6104option splice-request
6105no option splice-request
6106 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6108 yes | yes | yes | yes
6109 Arguments : none
6110
6111 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006112 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006113 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6114 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6115 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6116 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6117
6118 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6119
6120 Example :
6121 option splice-request
6122
6123 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6124 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6125
6126 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6127 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6128
6129
6130option splice-response
6131no option splice-response
6132 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6134 yes | yes | yes | yes
6135 Arguments : none
6136
6137 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006138 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006139 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6140 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6141 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6142 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6143
6144 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6145
6146 Example :
6147 option splice-response
6148
6149 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6150 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6151
6152 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6153 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6154
6155
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006156option srvtcpka
6157no option srvtcpka
6158 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6160 yes | no | yes | yes
6161 Arguments : none
6162
6163 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6164 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6165 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6166 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6167
6168 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6169 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6170 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6171 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6172
6173 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6174 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6175 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6176 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6177 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6178
6179 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6180
6181 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6182 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6183 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6184
6185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6187
6188 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6189
6190
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006191option ssl-hello-chk
6192 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6194 yes | no | yes | yes
6195 Arguments : none
6196
6197 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6198 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6199 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6200 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6201 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6202 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6203 hello message.
6204
6205 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6206 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6207 messages, which is appreciable.
6208
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006209 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6210 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6211 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006212
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006213 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6214
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006215
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006216option tcp-check
6217 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6219 yes | no | yes | yes
6220
6221 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6222 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6223
6224 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6225 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6226 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6227
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006228 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006229 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6230 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6231 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6232 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6233 only.
6234
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006235 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006236 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6237 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6238 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6239 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6240
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006241 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006242 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6243 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006244 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006245 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6246 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6247 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6248 the respective protocols.
6249 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6250 analysed.
6251
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006252 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6253 script.
6254
6255 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6256 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6257 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6258 The "comment" is of course optional.
6259
6260
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006261 Examples :
6262 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6263 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006264 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006265
6266 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6267 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006268 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006269
6270 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6271 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006272 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006273 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006274 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006275 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006276 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006277 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006278 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6279 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006280 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006281 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6282 tcp-check expect string +OK
6283
6284 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6285 (send many headers before analyzing)
6286 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006287 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006288 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6289 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6290 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6291 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006292 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006293
6294
6295 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6296
6297
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006298option tcp-smart-accept
6299no option tcp-smart-accept
6300 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6302 yes | yes | yes | no
6303 Arguments : none
6304
6305 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6306 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6307 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6308 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6309 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6310 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6311
6312 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6313 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6314 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6315 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6316
6317 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6318 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6319 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6320 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6321
6322 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6323 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6324 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6325
6326 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6327 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6328 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6329
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006330 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6331
6332
6333option tcp-smart-connect
6334no option tcp-smart-connect
6335 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6337 yes | no | yes | yes
6338 Arguments : none
6339
6340 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6341 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6342 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6343 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6344 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6345
6346 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6347 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6348 complex.
6349
6350 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6351 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6352 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6353
6354 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6355 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6356
6357 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6358
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006359
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006360option tcpka
6361 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6363 yes | yes | yes | yes
6364 Arguments : none
6365
6366 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6367 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6368 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6369 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6370
6371 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6372 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6373 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6374 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6375
6376 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6377 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6378 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6379 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6380 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6381
6382 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6383
6384 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6385 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6386 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6387 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6388 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6389 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6390 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6391 backends.
6392
6393 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6394
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006395
6396option tcplog
6397 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | yes | yes | yes
6400 Arguments : none
6401
6402 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6403 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6404 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6405 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6406 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6407 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6408 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6409 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6410
6411 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006413 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006414
6415
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006416option transparent
6417no option transparent
6418 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006420 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006421 Arguments : none
6422
6423 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6424 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6425 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6426 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6427 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6428 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6429 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6430 appropriate server.
6431
6432 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6433 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6434
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006435 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006436 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006437
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006438
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006439external-check command <command>
6440 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6442 yes | no | yes | yes
6443
6444 Arguments :
6445 <command> is the external command to run
6446
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006447 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6448
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006449 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006450
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006451 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6452 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6453 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6454 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6455 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6456 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006457
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006458 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6459
6460 Environment variables :
6461 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6462 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6463
6464 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6465
6466 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6467
6468 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6469 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6470 for a UNIX socket).
6471
6472 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6473
6474 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6475
6476 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6477
6478 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6479
6480 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6481
6482 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6483 socket).
6484
6485 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6486 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6487
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006488 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6489 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6490 failed.
6491
6492 Example :
6493 external-check command /bin/true
6494
6495 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6496
6497
6498external-check path <path>
6499 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6501 yes | no | yes | yes
6502
6503 Arguments :
6504 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6505
6506 The default path is "".
6507
6508 Example :
6509 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6510
6511 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6512 "external-check command"
6513
6514
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006515persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006516persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006517 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6519 yes | no | yes | yes
6520 Arguments :
6521 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006522 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6523 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006524
6525 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6526 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6527 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6528 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6529 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6530 forwarded to this server.
6531
6532 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6533 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6534 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006535 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006536 a single "listen" section.
6537
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006538 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6539 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6540 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6541
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006542 Example :
6543 listen tse-farm
6544 bind :3389
6545 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6546 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6547 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6548 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6549 persist rdp-cookie
6550 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006551 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006552 balance rdp-cookie
6553 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6554 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6555
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006556 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6557 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006558
6559
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006560rate-limit sessions <rate>
6561 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6563 yes | yes | yes | no
6564 Arguments :
6565 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6566 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6567
6568 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6569 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6570 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6571 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6572 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6573 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6574
6575 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6576 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6577 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6578 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6579
6580 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6581 listen smtp
6582 mode tcp
6583 bind :25
6584 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006585 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006586
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006587 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6588 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6589 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006590
6591 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6592
6593
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006594redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6595redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6596redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006597 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6599 no | yes | yes | yes
6600
6601 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006602 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006603
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006604 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006605 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006606 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6607 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6608 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006609
6610 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6611 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6612 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6613 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6614 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006615 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6616 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6617 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6618 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006619
6620 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6621 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6622 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6623 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6624 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6625 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006626 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006627 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006628 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6629 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6630 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006631
6632 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006633 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6634 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6635 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006636 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006637 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6638 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6639 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6640 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006641
6642 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6643 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6644
6645 - "drop-query"
6646 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6647 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6648 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6649 with a location-type redirect.
6650
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006651 - "append-slash"
6652 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6653 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6654 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6655 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6656
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006657 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6658 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6659 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6660 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6661 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6662 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6663 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6664
6665 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6666 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6667 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6668 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6669 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6670 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6671 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006672
6673 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6674 acl clear dst_port 80
6675 acl secure dst_port 8080
6676 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006677 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006678 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006679 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6680
6681 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006682 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6683 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6684 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006685 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006686
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006687 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6688 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6689 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6690
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006691 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006692 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006693
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006694 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006695 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6696 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6697 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006698
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006699 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006700
6701
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006702redisp (deprecated)
6703redispatch (deprecated)
6704 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6705 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6706 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006707 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006708
6709 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6710 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6711 be able to access the service anymore.
6712
6713 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6714 redistribute them to a working server.
6715
6716 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6717 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6718 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006720 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6721 "option redispatch" instead.
6722
6723 See also : "option redispatch"
6724
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006725
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006726reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006727 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6729 no | yes | yes | yes
6730 Arguments :
6731 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6732 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006733 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006734
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006735 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6736 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6737
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006738 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6739 the last header of an HTTP request.
6740
6741 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6742 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6743 responses.
6744
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006745 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6746 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6747 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6748
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006749 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6750 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006751
6752
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006753reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6754reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006755 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6757 no | yes | yes | yes
6758 Arguments :
6759 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6760 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6761 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6762 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6763 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6764 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6765 ignores case.
6766
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006767 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6768 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6769
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006770 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6771 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6772 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6773 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006774 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006775
6776 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6777 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6778
6779 Example :
6780 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6781 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6782 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6783
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006784 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6785 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006786
6787
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006788reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6789reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006790 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6792 no | yes | yes | yes
6793 Arguments :
6794 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6795 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6796 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6797 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6798 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6799 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6800
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006801 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6802 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6803
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006804 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6805 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6806 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6807 next servers.
6808
6809 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6810 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6811 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6812
6813 Example :
6814 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6815 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6816 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6817
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006818 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6819 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006820
6821
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006822reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6823reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006824 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6826 no | yes | yes | yes
6827 Arguments :
6828 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6829 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6830 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6831 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6832 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6833 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6834 case.
6835
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006836 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6837 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6838
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006839 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6840 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6841 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6842 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006843 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006844
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006845 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006846 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006847 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006848
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006849 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6850 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6851
6852 Example :
6853 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6854 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6855 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6856
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006857 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6858 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006859
6860
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006861reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6862reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006863 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6865 no | yes | yes | yes
6866 Arguments :
6867 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6868 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6869 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6870 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6871 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6872 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6873 case.
6874
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006875 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6876 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6877
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006878 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6879 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6880 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6881 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6882
6883 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6884 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6885
6886 Example :
6887 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6888 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6889 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6890 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6891
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006892 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6893 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006894
6895
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006896reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6897reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006898 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6900 no | yes | yes | yes
6901 Arguments :
6902 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6903 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6904 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6905 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6906 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6907 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6908
6909 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6910 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6911 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6912 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006913 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006914
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006915 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6916 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6917
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006918 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6919 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6920 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6921
6922 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6923 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6924 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6925 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6926 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6927
6928 Example :
6929 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006930 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006931 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6932 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6933
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006934 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
6935 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006936
6937
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006938reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6939reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006940 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6942 no | yes | yes | yes
6943 Arguments :
6944 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6945 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6946 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6947 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6948 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6949 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
6950 ignores case.
6951
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006952 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6953 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6954
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006955 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6956 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006957 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
6958 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
6959 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006960 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
6961 not set.
6962
6963 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
6964 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
6965 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
6966 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
6967 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
6968
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006969 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006970 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
6971 # block all others.
6972 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
6973 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
6974
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006975 # block bad guys
6976 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
6977 reqitarpit . if badguys
6978
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006979 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
6980 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006981
6982
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006983retries <value>
6984 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
6985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6986 yes | no | yes | yes
6987 Arguments :
6988 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
6989 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
6990 default value is 3.
6991
6992 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
6993 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
6994 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
6995
6996 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006997 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
6998 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02006999
7000 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7001 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7002
7003 See also : "option redispatch"
7004
7005
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007006rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007007 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7009 no | yes | yes | yes
7010 Arguments :
7011 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7012 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007013 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007014
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007015 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7016 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7017
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007018 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7019 the last header of an HTTP response.
7020
7021 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7022 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7023 responses.
7024
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007025 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7026 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007027
7028
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007029rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7030rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007031 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7033 no | yes | yes | yes
7034 Arguments :
7035 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7036 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7037 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7038 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7039 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7040 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7041 ignores case.
7042
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007043 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7044 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7045
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007046 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7047 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007048 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007049 client.
7050
7051 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7052 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7053 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7054
7055 Example :
7056 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007057 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007058
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007059 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7060 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007061
7062
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007063rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7064rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007065 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7067 no | yes | yes | yes
7068 Arguments :
7069 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7070 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7071 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7072 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7073 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7074 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7075 ignores case.
7076
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007077 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7078 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7079
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007080 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7081 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7082 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7083 case-sensitive.
7084
7085 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007086 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7087 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7088 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007089
7090 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7091 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7092
7093 Example :
7094 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7095 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7096
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007097 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7098 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007099
7100
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007101rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7102rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007103 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7105 no | yes | yes | yes
7106 Arguments :
7107 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7108 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7109 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7110 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7111 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7112 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7113 ignores case.
7114
7115 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7116 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7117 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7118 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007119 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007120
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007121 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7122 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7123
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007124 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7125 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7126 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7127
7128 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7129 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7130 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7131 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7132 are not case-sensitive.
7133
7134 Example :
7135 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7136 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7137
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007138 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7139 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007140
7141
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007142server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007143 Declare a server in a backend
7144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7145 no | no | yes | yes
7146 Arguments :
7147 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007148 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007149 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007150
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007151 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7152 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7153 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7154 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007155 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7156 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7157 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7158 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7159 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007160 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7161 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7162 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7163 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7164 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7165 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7166 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007167 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007168 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7169 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7170 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007171
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007172 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007173 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7174 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7175 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7176 adding this value to the client's port.
7177
7178 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7179 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007180 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007181
7182 Examples :
7183 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7184 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007185 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007186 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7187 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7188 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007189
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007190 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7191 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7192 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7193 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7194 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7195
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007196 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7197 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007198
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007199server-state-file-name [<file>]
7200 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7201 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7202 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7203 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7204 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7205 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7206
7207 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7208 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7209
7210 global
7211 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7212
7213 backend bk
7214 load-server-state-from-file
7215
7216 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7217 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007218
7219source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007220source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007221source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007222 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7224 yes | no | yes | yes
7225 Arguments :
7226 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7227 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007228
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007229 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007230 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7231 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7232 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7233 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7234 supported prefixes are :
7235 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7236 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7237 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007238 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007239 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7240 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007241
7242 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7243 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007244 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7245 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7246 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007247
7248 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7249 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7250 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7251 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7252 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7253 <addr>.
7254
7255 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7256 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7257 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7258 port.
7259
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007260 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7261 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7262 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7263 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007264 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007265 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7266 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7267 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7268 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7269 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7270 HTTP header.
7271
7272 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7273 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007274 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007275 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7276 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7277 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7278 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7279 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7280 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7281 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7282
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007283 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7284 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7285 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7286 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7287 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7288 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7289
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007290 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7291 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7292 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7293 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7294
7295 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7296 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7297 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7298 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7299 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7300 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7301
7302 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7303 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7304 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7305 there are two methods :
7306
7307 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7308 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7309 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7310 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7311 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7312 of the client ranges may be used.
7313
7314 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7315 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7316 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7317 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7318 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7319 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7320 same session.
7321
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007322 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7323 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7324 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007325 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007326
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007327 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7328
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007329 Examples :
7330 backend private
7331 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7332 source 192.168.1.200
7333
7334 backend transparent_ssl1
7335 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7336 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7337
7338 backend transparent_ssl2
7339 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7340 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7341 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7342
7343 backend transparent_ssl3
7344 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7345 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7346 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7347
7348 backend transparent_smtp
7349 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7350 # with Tproxy version 4.
7351 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7352
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007353 backend transparent_http
7354 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7355 # proxy.
7356 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7357
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007358 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007359 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007361
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007362srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7363 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7365 yes | no | yes | yes
7366 Arguments :
7367 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7368 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7369 as explained at the top of this document.
7370
7371 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7372 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7373 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7374 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7375 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7376 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7377 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7378
7379 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7380 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7381 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7382 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7383 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007384 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007385 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007386 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007387
7388 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7389 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7390 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7391 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7392 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7393 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7394
7395 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7396 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7397
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007398 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7399 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007400
7401
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007402stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7403 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007405 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007406
7407 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7408 matched.
7409
7410 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7411 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7412
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007413 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7414 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7415 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7416
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007417 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7418 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7419 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7420 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007421
7422 Example :
7423 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7424 backend stats_localhost
7425 stats enable
7426 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7427
7428 Example :
7429 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7430 backend stats_auth
7431 stats enable
7432 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7433 stats admin if TRUE
7434
7435 Example :
7436 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7437 userlist stats-auth
7438 group admin users admin
7439 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7440 group readonly users haproxy
7441 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7442
7443 backend stats_auth
7444 stats enable
7445 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7446 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7447 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7448 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7449
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007450 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7451 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7452 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007453
7454
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007455stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7456 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007458 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007459 Arguments :
7460 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7461
7462 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7463
7464 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7465 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7466 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7467 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7468 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7469 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7470
7471 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7472 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7473 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007474 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007475
7476 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7477 report using "stats scope".
7478
7479 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7480 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7481 unobvious parameters.
7482
7483 Example :
7484 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7485 backend public_www
7486 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7487 stats enable
7488 stats hide-version
7489 stats scope .
7490 stats uri /admin?stats
7491 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7492 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7493 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7494
7495 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7496 backend private_monitoring
7497 stats enable
7498 stats uri /admin?stats
7499 stats refresh 5s
7500
7501 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7502
7503
7504stats enable
7505 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007507 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007508 Arguments : none
7509
7510 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7511 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7512 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7513 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7514 - stats auth : no authentication
7515 - stats scope : no restriction
7516
7517 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7518 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7519 unobvious parameters.
7520
7521 Example :
7522 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7523 backend public_www
7524 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7525 stats enable
7526 stats hide-version
7527 stats scope .
7528 stats uri /admin?stats
7529 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7530 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7531 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7532
7533 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7534 backend private_monitoring
7535 stats enable
7536 stats uri /admin?stats
7537 stats refresh 5s
7538
7539 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7540
7541
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007542stats hide-version
7543 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007545 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007546 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007547
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007548 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7549 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7550 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7551 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7552 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7553 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007554
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007555 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7556 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7557 unobvious parameters.
7558
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007559 Example :
7560 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7561 backend public_www
7562 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007563 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007564 stats hide-version
7565 stats scope .
7566 stats uri /admin?stats
7567 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7568 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7569 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007570
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007571 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7572 backend private_monitoring
7573 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007574 stats uri /admin?stats
7575 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007576
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007577 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007578
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007579
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007580stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7581 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7582 Access control for statistics
7583
7584 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7585 no | no | yes | yes
7586
7587 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7588 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7589 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7590 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7591 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7592 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7593
7594 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7595 instance.
7596
7597 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7598 about ACL usage.
7599
7600
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007601stats realm <realm>
7602 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007604 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007605 Arguments :
7606 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7607 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7608 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7609
7610 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7611 using a backslash ('\').
7612
7613 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7614 only related to authentication.
7615
7616 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7617 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7618 unobvious parameters.
7619
7620 Example :
7621 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7622 backend public_www
7623 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7624 stats enable
7625 stats hide-version
7626 stats scope .
7627 stats uri /admin?stats
7628 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7629 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7630 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7631
7632 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7633 backend private_monitoring
7634 stats enable
7635 stats uri /admin?stats
7636 stats refresh 5s
7637
7638 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7639
7640
7641stats refresh <delay>
7642 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007644 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007645 Arguments :
7646 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7647 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7648 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7649 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7650 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7651 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7652
7653 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7654 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7655 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7656 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7657
7658 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7659 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7660 unobvious parameters.
7661
7662 Example :
7663 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7664 backend public_www
7665 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7666 stats enable
7667 stats hide-version
7668 stats scope .
7669 stats uri /admin?stats
7670 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7671 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7672 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7673
7674 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7675 backend private_monitoring
7676 stats enable
7677 stats uri /admin?stats
7678 stats refresh 5s
7679
7680 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7681
7682
7683stats scope { <name> | "." }
7684 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007686 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007687 Arguments :
7688 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7689 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7690 section in which the statement appears.
7691
7692 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7693 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7694 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7695 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7696 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7697 exists.
7698
7699 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7700 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7701 unobvious parameters.
7702
7703 Example :
7704 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7705 backend public_www
7706 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7707 stats enable
7708 stats hide-version
7709 stats scope .
7710 stats uri /admin?stats
7711 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7712 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7713 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7714
7715 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7716 backend private_monitoring
7717 stats enable
7718 stats uri /admin?stats
7719 stats refresh 5s
7720
7721 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7722
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007723
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007724stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007725 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007727 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007728
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007729 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007730 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7731
7732 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7733 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7734
7735 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7736 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007737 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007738
7739 Example :
7740 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7741 backend private_monitoring
7742 stats enable
7743 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7744 stats uri /admin?stats
7745 stats refresh 5s
7746
7747 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7748 global section.
7749
7750
7751stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007752 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7754 yes | yes | yes | yes
7755 Arguments : none
7756
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007757 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007758 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7759 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7760 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7761 - IP (socket, server)
7762 - cookie (backend, server)
7763
7764 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7765 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007766 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007767
7768 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7769
7770
7771stats show-node [ <name> ]
7772 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007774 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007775 Arguments:
7776 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7777 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7778
7779 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7780 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007781 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007782
7783 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7784 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7785 unobvious parameters.
7786
7787 Example:
7788 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7789 backend private_monitoring
7790 stats enable
7791 stats show-node Europe-1
7792 stats uri /admin?stats
7793 stats refresh 5s
7794
7795 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7796 section.
7797
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007798
7799stats uri <prefix>
7800 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007802 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007803 Arguments :
7804 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7805 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7806 query string.
7807
7808 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7809 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7810 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7811 possible to reach it in the application.
7812
7813 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007814 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007815 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7816 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7817 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7818 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7819
7820 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7821 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7822 an address or a port to statistics only.
7823
7824 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7825 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7826 unobvious parameters.
7827
7828 Example :
7829 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7830 backend public_www
7831 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7832 stats enable
7833 stats hide-version
7834 stats scope .
7835 stats uri /admin?stats
7836 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7837 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7838 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7839
7840 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7841 backend private_monitoring
7842 stats enable
7843 stats uri /admin?stats
7844 stats refresh 5s
7845
7846 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7847
7848
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007849stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7850 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007852 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007853
7854 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007855 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007856 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7857 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7858 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7859
7860 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7861 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7862 the "stick-table" statement.
7863
7864 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7865 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7866 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7867 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7868 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7869
7870 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7871 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7872 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7873 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7874 transformation rules.
7875
7876 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7877 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7878 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7879 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7880 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7881 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7882 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7883
7884 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7885 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7886 ACL based conditions.
7887
7888 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7889 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7890 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7891 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7892
7893 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7894 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7895 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7896 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7897
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007898 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7899 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7900 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7901
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007902 Example :
7903 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7904 # last 30 minutes
7905 backend pop
7906 mode tcp
7907 balance roundrobin
7908 stick store-request src
7909 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7910 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7911 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7912
7913 backend smtp
7914 mode tcp
7915 balance roundrobin
7916 stick match src table pop
7917 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7918 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7919
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007920 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007921 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007922
7923
7924stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7925 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7927 no | no | yes | yes
7928
7929 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7930 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7931 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7932 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7933
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007934 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7935 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7936 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7937
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007938 Examples :
7939 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007940 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007941
7942 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
7943 stick match src table pop if !localhost
7944 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
7945
7946
7947 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
7948 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
7949 backend http
7950 mode http
7951 balance roundrobin
7952 stick on src table https
7953 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
7954 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
7955 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
7956
7957 backend https
7958 mode tcp
7959 balance roundrobin
7960 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7961 stick on src
7962 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7963 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7964
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007965 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007966
7967
7968stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7969 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7971 no | no | yes | yes
7972
7973 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007974 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007975 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7976 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7977 server is selected.
7978
7979 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7980 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7981 the "stick-table" statement.
7982
7983 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7984 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7985 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
7986 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
7987 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
7988 address.
7989
7990 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7991 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
7992 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
7993 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
7994 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
7995 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
7996 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
7997 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
7998 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
7999 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8000
8001 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8002 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8003 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8004 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8005 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8006 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8007 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8008
8009 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8010 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8011 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8012 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8013
8014 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8015 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8016 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8017 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8018 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8019 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008020 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8021 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8022 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8023 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8024 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8025 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008026
8027 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8028 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8029 the request.
8030
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008031 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8032 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8033 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8034
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008035 Example :
8036 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8037 # last 30 minutes
8038 backend pop
8039 mode tcp
8040 balance roundrobin
8041 stick store-request src
8042 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8043 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8044 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8045
8046 backend smtp
8047 mode tcp
8048 balance roundrobin
8049 stick match src table pop
8050 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8051 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8052
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008053 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008054 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008055
8056
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008057stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008058 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8059 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008060 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008062 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008063
8064 Arguments :
8065 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8066 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8067 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8068 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8069
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008070 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8071 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8072 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8073 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8074
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008075 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8076 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8077 instance.
8078
8079 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8080 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8081 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8082 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8083 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8084 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008085 to 32 characters.
8086
8087 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8088 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8089 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008090 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008091 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8092 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008093
8094 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008095 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8096 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008097 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8098 increase.
8099
8100 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008101 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8102 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8103 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008104
8105 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8106 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8107 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8108 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8109 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8110 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8111 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8112 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8113 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8114 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8115 parameter (see below).
8116
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008117 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8118 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8119 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8120 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8121 soft restart.
8122
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008123 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8124 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008125
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008126 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8127 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8128 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8129 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8130 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008131 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008132 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8133 if not expiration delay is specified.
8134
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008135 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8136 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8137 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8138 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008139 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8140 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8141 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8142 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8143 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8144 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8145 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8146 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8147 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8148 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8149 types and their arguments.
8150
8151 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8152 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8153 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8154 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8155
8156 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8157 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8158 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8159 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8160
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008161 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8162 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8163 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8164 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8165 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8166 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8167
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008168 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8169 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8170 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8171 they were received.
8172
8173 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8174 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8175 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8176 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8177 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8178
8179 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8180 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8181 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8182 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8183 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8184
8185 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8186 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8187 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8188
8189 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8190 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8191 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8192 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8193 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8194
8195 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8196 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8197 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8198 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8199 the client side.
8200
8201 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8202 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8203 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8204 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8205 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8206 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8207 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8208
8209 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8210 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8211 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8212 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8213 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8214 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8215 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8216
8217 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8218 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8219 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8220 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8221 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8222 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8223
8224 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8225 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8226 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8227 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8228
8229 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8230 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8231 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8232 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8233 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8234 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8235 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8236 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8237 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8238 recommended for better fairness.
8239
8240 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8241 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8242 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8243 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8244
8245 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8246 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8247 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8248 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8249 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8250 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8251 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8252 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8253 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8254 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008255
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008256 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8257 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008258 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8259 reference it.
8260
8261 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8262 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008263 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8264 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8265 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008266
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008267 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8268 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8269 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8270 something that can be ignored.
8271
8272 Example:
8273 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8274 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8275 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8276 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8277
8278 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008279 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008280
8281
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008282stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008283 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8285 no | no | yes | yes
8286
8287 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008288 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008289 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8290 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8291 server is selected.
8292
8293 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8294 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8295 the "stick-table" statement.
8296
8297 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8298 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8299 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8300 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8301
8302 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8303 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8304 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8305 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8306 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8307 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008308 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008309 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8310 rules.
8311
8312 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8313 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8314 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8315 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8316 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8317 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8318 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8319
8320 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8321 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8322 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8323 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8324
8325 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8326 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8327 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8328 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8329 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8330 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008331 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8332 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8333 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8334 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8335 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8336 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8337 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8338 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8339 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008340
8341 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8342
8343 Example :
8344 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8345 backend https
8346 mode tcp
8347 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008348 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008349 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008350
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008351 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8352 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8353
8354 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8355 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8356 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8357
8358 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8359 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008360
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008361 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8362 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8363 # at offset 44.
8364
8365 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8366 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8367
8368 # Learn on response if server hello.
8369 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008370
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008371 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8372 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8373
8374 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8375 extraction.
8376
8377
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008378tcp-check connect [params*]
8379 Opens a new connection
8380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8381 no | no | yes | yes
8382
8383 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8384 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8385 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8386
8387 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8388 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8389 of the sequence.
8390
8391 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8392 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8393 do.
8394
8395 Parameters :
8396 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8397 use the TCP connection.
8398
8399 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8400 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8401 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8402
8403 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8404
8405 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8406
8407 Examples:
8408 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8409 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8410 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8411 option tcp-check
8412 tcp-check connect
8413 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8414 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8415 tcp-check send \r\n
8416 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8417 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8418 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8419 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8420 tcp-check send \r\n
8421 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8422 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8423
8424 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8425 option tcp-check
8426 tcp-check connect port 110
8427 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8428 tcp-check connect port 143
8429 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8430 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8431
8432 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8433
8434
8435tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8436 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8437 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8438 no | no | yes | yes
8439
8440 Arguments :
8441 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8442 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8443 binary.
8444 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8445 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8446 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8447
8448 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8449 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8450 with the usual backslash ('\').
8451 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8452 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8453 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8454 used upper or lower case.
8455
8456
8457 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8458
8459 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8460 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8461 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8462 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8463 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8464 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8465 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8466 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8467
8468 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8469 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8470 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8471 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8472 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8473 expression.
8474
8475 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8476 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8477 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8478 this exact hexadecimal string.
8479 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8480
8481 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8482 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8483 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8484 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8485 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8486 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8487 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8488 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8489 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8490 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8491 the null character.
8492
8493 Examples :
8494 # perform a POP check
8495 option tcp-check
8496 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8497
8498 # perform an IMAP check
8499 option tcp-check
8500 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8501
8502 # look for the redis master server
8503 option tcp-check
8504 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008505 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008506 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8507 tcp-check expect string role:master
8508 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8509 tcp-check expect string +OK
8510
8511
8512 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8513 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8514
8515
8516tcp-check send <data>
8517 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8518 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8519 no | no | yes | yes
8520
8521 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8522 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8523
8524 Examples :
8525 # look for the redis master server
8526 option tcp-check
8527 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8528 tcp-check expect string role:master
8529
8530 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8531 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8532
8533
8534tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8535 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8536 tcp health check
8537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8538 no | no | yes | yes
8539
8540 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8541 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8542 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8543 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8544 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8545 hexadecimal string.
8546 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8547
8548 Examples :
8549 # redis check in binary
8550 option tcp-check
8551 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8552 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8553
8554
8555 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8556 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8557
8558
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008559tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8560 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8562 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008563 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008564 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8565 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008566
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008567 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008568
8569 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8570 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008571 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8572 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8573 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8574 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8575 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8576 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008577
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008578 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8579 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8580 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8581 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008582
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008583 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008584 - accept :
8585 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8586 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8587 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008589 - reject :
8590 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8591 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8592 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8593 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8594 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8595 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8596 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8597 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8598 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8599 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8600 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8601 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008602
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008603 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8604 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8605 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8606 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8607 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8608 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8609 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8610 hosts.
8611
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008612 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8613 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8614 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8615 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8616 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8617 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8618 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8619 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8620 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008621 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8622 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008623
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008624 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008625 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008626 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008627 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008628 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8629 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008630 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008631 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8632 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8633 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8634 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8635 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008636
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008637 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008638 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008639 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008640 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8641 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8642 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8643 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008644
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008645 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8646 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8647 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8648 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008649
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008650 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8651 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8652 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8653 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8654 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008655 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8656 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8657 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8658 layer7 information is extracted.
8659
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008660 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8661 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8662 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8663 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8664 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008665
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008666 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8667 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8668 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8669 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8670
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008671 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8672 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8673 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8674 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8675 continues.
8676
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008677 - "silent-drop" :
8678 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8679 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8680 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8681 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8682 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8683 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8684 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8685 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8686 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8687 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8688 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8689 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8690 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8691 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8692 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8693 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8694
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008695 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8696 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8697 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008698
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008699 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8700 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8701 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008702
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008703 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008704 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008705 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008706
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008707 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8708 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8709 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008710
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008711 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008712 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8713 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008714
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008715 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8716
8717 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8718
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008719 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8720
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008721 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008722
8723
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008724tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8725 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008727 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008728 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008729 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8730 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008731
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008732 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008733
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008734 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8735 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8736 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8737 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8738 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008739
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008740 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8741 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8742 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8743 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008744 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8745 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8746 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8747 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8748 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8749 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008750 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008751 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008752
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008753 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8754 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8755 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8756 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008757
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008758 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008759 - accept : the request is accepted
8760 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8761 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008762 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008763 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008764 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008765 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008766 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008767
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008768 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8769 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008770
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008771 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8772 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8773 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8774 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8775 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8776 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008778 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008779 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8780 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008781
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008782 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008783 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8784 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8785 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8786 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008787 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8788 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8789 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008790
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008791 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008792 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8793 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8794 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008795
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008796 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8797 declared inline.
8798
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008799 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8800 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8801 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8802 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008803 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008804 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008805 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008806 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8807 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008808 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008809 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8810 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008811
8812 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8813 followed by some converters.
8814
8815 Example:
8816
8817 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8818
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008819 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008820 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8821 # and reject everything else.
8822 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8823 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008824 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008825 tcp-request content reject
8826
8827 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008828 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8829 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8830 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008831 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008832
8833 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8834 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8835 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008836 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008837 tcp-request content reject
8838
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008839 Example:
8840 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8841 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008842 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008843
8844 Example:
8845 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8846 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008847 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008849 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8850 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8851
8852 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008853 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008854 # protecting all our sites
8855 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008856 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8857 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008858 ...
8859 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8860
8861 backend http_dynamic
8862 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008863 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008864 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008865 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8866 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8867 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008868 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008870 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008871
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008872 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008873
8874
8875tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
8876 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
8877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008878 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008879 Arguments :
8880 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8881 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8882 as explained at the top of this document.
8883
8884 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
8885 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
8886 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
8887 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
8888 data for at most the specified amount of time.
8889
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008890 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
8891 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
8892 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
8893 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
8894
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008895 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
8896 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008897 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008898 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01008899 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
8900 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
8901 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
8902 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008903
8904 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
8905 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
8906 it pass through unaffected.
8907
8908 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
8909 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
8910 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008911 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008912 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
8913 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02008914 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
8915 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
8916 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008917
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008918 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008919 "timeout client".
8920
8921
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008922tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8923 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
8924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8925 no | no | yes | yes
8926 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008927 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8928 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008929
8930 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
8931
8932 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
8933 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8934 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008935 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
8936 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008937
8938 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
8939
8940 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8941 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8942 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8943 inserted.
8944
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008945 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008946 - accept :
8947 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8948 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8949 the rules evaluation.
8950
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008951 - close :
8952 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
8953 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
8954 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
8955 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
8956 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
8957 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008958 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02008959 protocols.
8960
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008961 - reject :
8962 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8963 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008964 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008965
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008966 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
8967 Sets a variable.
8968
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008969 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8970 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8971 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
8972 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
8973
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008974 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
8975 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8976 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8977 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8978 continues.
8979
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008980 - "silent-drop" :
8981 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8982 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8983 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8984 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8985 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8986 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8987 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8988 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8989 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8990 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8991 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8992 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8993 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8994 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8995 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8996 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8997
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02008998 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8999 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9000 for changing the default action to a reject.
9001
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009002 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9003 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9004 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9005 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009006 period.
9007
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009008 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9009 declared inline.
9010
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009011 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9012 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9013 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9014 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009015 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009016 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009017 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009018 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9019 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009020 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009021 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9022 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009023
9024 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9025 followed by some converters.
9026
9027 Example:
9028
9029 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9030
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009031 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9032
9033 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9034
9035
9036tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9037 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9039 no | no | yes | yes
9040 Arguments :
9041 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9043 as explained at the top of this document.
9044
9045 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9046
9047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009048timeout check <timeout>
9049 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9050 established.
9051
9052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9053 yes | no | yes | yes
9054 Arguments:
9055 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9056 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9057 as explained at the top of this document.
9058
9059 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9060 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9061 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9062 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009063 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9064 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9065 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009066
9067 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9068 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9069
9070 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9071 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009072 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009073
9074 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9075 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9076 forget about it.
9077
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009078 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9079 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009080
9081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009082timeout client <timeout>
9083timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9084 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9086 yes | yes | yes | no
9087 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009088 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009089 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9090 as explained at the top of this document.
9091
9092 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9093 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9094 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009095 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9096 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9097 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9098 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009099 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9100 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9101 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009102 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009103 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009104 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9105 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009106 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9107 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009108
9109 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9110 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9111 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9112 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9113 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9114 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9115
9116 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9117 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9118 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9119
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009120 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9121 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009122
9123
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009124timeout client-fin <timeout>
9125 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9127 yes | yes | yes | no
9128 Arguments :
9129 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9130 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9131 as explained at the top of this document.
9132
9133 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9134 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9135 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9136 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9137 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9138 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9139 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9140 down in one direction.
9141
9142 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9143 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9144 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9145
9146 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9147
9148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009149timeout connect <timeout>
9150timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9151 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9153 yes | no | yes | yes
9154 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009155 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009156 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9157 as explained at the top of this document.
9158
9159 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009160 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009161 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009162 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009163 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9164 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009165
9166 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9167 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9168 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9169 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9170 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9171 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9172
9173 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9174 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9175 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9176
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009177 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9178 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009179
9180
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009181timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9182 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9184 yes | yes | yes | yes
9185 Arguments :
9186 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9187 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9188 as explained at the top of this document.
9189
9190 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9191 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9192 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9193 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9194 once the request has started to present itself.
9195
9196 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9197 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9198 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9199 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9200 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9201
9202 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9203 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9204 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9205 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9206
9207 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9208 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9209 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9210 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9211 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009212 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009213
9214 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9215 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9216 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9217 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9218
9219 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9220
9221
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009222timeout http-request <timeout>
9223 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009225 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009226 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009227 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009228 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9229 as explained at the top of this document.
9230
9231 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9232 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9233 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9234 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9235 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9236 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9237 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009238 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9239 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9240 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9241 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9242 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009243 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9244 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009245
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009246 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9247 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9248 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9249 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9250 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009251 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009252
9253 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9254 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9255 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9256 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9257 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9258
9259 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009260 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9261 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9262 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009263
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009264 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009265 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009266
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009267
9268timeout queue <timeout>
9269 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9271 yes | no | yes | yes
9272 Arguments :
9273 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9274 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9275 as explained at the top of this document.
9276
9277 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9278 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9279 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9280 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9281 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9282
9283 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9284 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9285 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9286 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9287
9288 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9289
9290
9291timeout server <timeout>
9292timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9293 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9295 yes | no | yes | yes
9296 Arguments :
9297 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9298 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9299 as explained at the top of this document.
9300
9301 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9302 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9303 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9304 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9305 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9306 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9307 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9308
9309 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9310 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9311 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9312 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9313 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009314 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009315 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009316 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9317 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9318 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9319 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009320
9321 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9322 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9323 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9324 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9325 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9326 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9327
9328 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9329 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9330 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9331
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009332 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009333
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009334
9335timeout server-fin <timeout>
9336 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9338 yes | no | yes | yes
9339 Arguments :
9340 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9341 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9342 as explained at the top of this document.
9343
9344 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9345 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9346 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9347 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9348 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9349 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9350 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9351 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9352 situations, it should not be needed.
9353
9354 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9355 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9356 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9357
9358 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9359
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009360
9361timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009362 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9364 yes | yes | yes | yes
9365 Arguments :
9366 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9367 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9368 as explained at the top of this document.
9369
9370 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9371 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9372 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9373
9374 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9375 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9376 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9377 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009378 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009379
9380 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9381
9382
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009383timeout tunnel <timeout>
9384 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 yes | no | yes | yes
9387 Arguments :
9388 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9389 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9390 as explained at the top of this document.
9391
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009392 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009393 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9394 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9395 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9396 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9397 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9398 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9399 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9400 specified.
9401
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009402 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9403 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9404 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9405 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9406 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9407 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9408 state.
9409
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009410 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9411 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9412 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9413 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9414 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9415
9416 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9417 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9418 forget about it.
9419
9420 Example :
9421 defaults http
9422 option http-server-close
9423 timeout connect 5s
9424 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009425 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009426 timeout server 30s
9427 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9428
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009429 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009430
9431
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009432transparent (deprecated)
9433 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009435 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009436 Arguments : none
9437
9438 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9439 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9440 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9441 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9442 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9443 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9444 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9445 appropriate server.
9446
9447 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9448
9449 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9450 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9451
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009452 See also: "option transparent"
9453
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009454unique-id-format <string>
9455 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9457 yes | yes | yes | no
9458 Arguments :
9459 <string> is a log-format string.
9460
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009461 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9462 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9463 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9464 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009465
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009466 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9467 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9468 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9469 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9470 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9471 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9472 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9473 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009474
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009475 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9476 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009477
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009478 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009479
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009480 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009481
9482 will generate:
9483
9484 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9485
9486 See also: "unique-id-header"
9487
9488unique-id-header <name>
9489 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9490 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9491 yes | yes | yes | no
9492 Arguments :
9493 <name> is the name of the header.
9494
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009495 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9496 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009497
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009498 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009499
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009500 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009501 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9502
9503 will generate:
9504
9505 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9506
9507 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009508
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009509use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009510 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9512 no | yes | yes | no
9513 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009514 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9515 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009516
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009517 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9518 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009519
9520 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9521 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9522 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009523 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9524 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9525 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9526 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009527
9528 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9529 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9530 assign the backend.
9531
9532 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9533 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9534 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9535 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9536 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9537 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9538
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009539 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009540 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009541 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9542 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9543 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9544
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009545 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9546 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9547 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9548 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9549 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9550 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9551 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9552 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9553 cannot be forced from the request.
9554
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009555 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009556 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9557 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9558
9559 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9560 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009561
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009562
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009563use-server <server> if <condition>
9564use-server <server> unless <condition>
9565 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9566 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9567 no | no | yes | yes
9568 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009569 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009570
9571 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9572
9573 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9574 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9575 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9576
9577 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9578 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9579 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9580 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9581 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9582 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9583 matches will assign the server.
9584
9585 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9586 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9587 with the next rules until one matches.
9588
9589 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9590 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9591 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9592 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9593
9594 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9595 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9596 stripped.
9597
9598 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9599 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9600 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9601 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9602
9603 Example :
9604 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9605 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9606 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9607 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9608 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9609 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9610 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9611 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9612 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9613
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009614 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009615
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009616
96175. Bind and Server options
9618--------------------------
9619
9620The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9621depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9622settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9623written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9624described in this section.
9625
9626
96275.1. Bind options
9628-----------------
9629
9630The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9631as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9632no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9633parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9634while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9635provided immediately after the setting name.
9636
9637The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9638
9639accept-proxy
9640 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009641 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9642 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009643 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9644 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9645 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9646 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9647 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9648 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9649 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009650 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9651 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009652
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009653alpn <protocols>
9654 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9655 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9656 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9657 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9658 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9659 initial NPN extension.
9660
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009661backlog <backlog>
9662 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9663 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9664
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009665ecdhe <named curve>
9666 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009667 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9668 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009669
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009670ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009671 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9672 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9673 client's certificate.
9674
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009675ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9677 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9678 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9679 error is ignored.
9680
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009681ca-sign-file <cafile>
9682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9683 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9684 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9685 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9686 'generate-certificates' for details.
9687
9688ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9690 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9691 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9692 'generate-certificates' for details.
9693
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009694ciphers <ciphers>
9695 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9696 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009697 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009698 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9699 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9700
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009701crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009702 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9703 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9704 to verify client's certificate.
9705
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009706crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9708 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9709 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9710 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9711 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9712 file.
9713
9714 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9715 are loaded.
9716
9717 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009718 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009719 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9720 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9721 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9722 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9723 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9724 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9725 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009726
9727 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9728 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9729 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9730 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009731 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9732 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009733
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009734 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009735
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009736 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9737 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009738 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009739 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9740 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9741 clients).
9742
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009743 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9744 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9745 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9746 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9747 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9748 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9749 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9750 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9751 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9752 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9753 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9754 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9755 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9756
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009757 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9758 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9759 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9760 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9761 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9762
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009763 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
9764 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
9765 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
9766 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009767
9768 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
9769 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
9770 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
9771 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
9772 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
9773 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
9774 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
9775 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
9776 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
9777
9778 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
9779
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009780 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009781 a cert bundle.
9782
9783 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
9784 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
9785 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
9786 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
9787 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
9788 provide multi-cert support.
9789
9790 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
9791
9792 Filename | CN | SAN
9793 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9794 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009795 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009796 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
9797 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9798
9799 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
9800 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
9801 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
9802 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
9803 suites.
9804
9805 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
9806 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
9807
9808 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
9809 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
9810 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
9811
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009812crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9814 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009815 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009816 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009817
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009818crt-list <file>
9819 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009820 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9821 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009822
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009823 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009824
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009825 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9826 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9827 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9828 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9829 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9830 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9831 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9832 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009833
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009834 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
9835 the base name is given in the crt-list. Due to the nature of bundling, all SNI
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009836 filters given to a multi-cert bundle entry are ignored.
9837
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009838defer-accept
9839 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9840 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9841 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9842 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9843 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9844 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9845 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9846 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9847 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9848 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9849 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9850
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009851force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009852 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009853 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009854 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9855 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009856
9857force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009858 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009859 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9860 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009861
9862force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009863 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009864 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9865 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009866
9867force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009868 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009869 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9870 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009871
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009872generate-certificates
9873 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9874 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
9875 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
9876 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
9877 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
9878 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
9879 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
9880 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
9881 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
9882 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
9883 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
9884
9885 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
9886 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
9887 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
9888 certificate is used many times.
9889
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009890gid <gid>
9891 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
9892 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
9893 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
9894 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
9895 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9896
9897group <group>
9898 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
9899 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
9900 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
9901 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
9902 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
9903
9904id <id>
9905 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
9906 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
9907 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
9908 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
9909
9910interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01009911 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
9912 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
9913 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
9914 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
9915 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
9916 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
9917 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009918
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02009919level <level>
9920 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
9921 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
9922 sockets. <level> can be one of :
9923 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
9924 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
9925 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
9926 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
9927 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
9928 counters).
9929 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
9930 all counters).
9931
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009932maxconn <maxconn>
9933 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
9934 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
9935 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
9936 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
9937 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
9938 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
9939 eat all memory.
9940
9941mode <mode>
9942 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
9943 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
9944 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
9945 UNIX sockets.
9946
9947mss <maxseg>
9948 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
9949 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
9950 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
9951 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
9952 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
9953 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
9954 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
9955 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
9956 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
9957 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
9958 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
9959
9960name <name>
9961 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
9962 page.
9963
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +02009964namespace <name>
9965 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
9966 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
9967 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
9968 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
9969
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009970nice <nice>
9971 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
9972 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
9973 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
9974 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
9975 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
9976 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
9977 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
9978 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
9979 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
9980 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
9981 one for an RDP socket.
9982
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009983no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009984 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009985 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009986 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009987 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
9988 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009989 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009990
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009991no-tls-tickets
9992 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9993 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9994 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009995 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
9996 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02009997
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009998no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010000 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010001 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010002 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10003 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10004 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010005
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010006no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010007 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010008 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010009 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010010 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10011 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10012 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010013
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010014no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010015 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010016 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010017 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010018 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10019 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10020 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010021
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010022npn <protocols>
10023 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10024 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10025 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10026 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010027 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10028 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010029
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010030process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10031 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10032 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10033 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10034 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10035 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10036 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10037 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010038 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10039 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10040 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10041 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10042 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10043 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10044 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010045
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010046ssl
10047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010048 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010049 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10050 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10051 to deciphered contents.
10052
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010053strict-sni
10054 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10055 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10056 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10057 See the "crt" option for more information.
10058
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010059tcp-ut <delay>
10060 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10061 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10062 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10063 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10064 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10065 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10066 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10067 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10068 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10069 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10070 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10071
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010072tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010073 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010074 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10075 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10076 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10077 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10078 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10079 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10080 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010081 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10082 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10083 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010084
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010085tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10086 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10087 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10088 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10089 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10090 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10091 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10092 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10093 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10094 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10095 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10096
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010097transparent
10098 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10099 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10100 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10101 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10102 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10103 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10104 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10105 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10106 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10107 so check for support with your vendor.
10108
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010109v4v6
10110 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10111 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10112 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10113 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010114 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010115
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010116v6only
10117 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10118 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10119 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010120 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10121 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010122
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010123uid <uid>
10124 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10125 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10126 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10127 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10128 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10129
10130user <user>
10131 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10132 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10133 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10134 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10135 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10136
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010137verify [none|optional|required]
10138 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10139 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10140 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10141 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10142 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010143 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10144 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10145 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10146 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010147
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200101485.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010149------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010151The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10152which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10153arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10154settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10155after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10156Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10157address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010159 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010160 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010161
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010162The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010163
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010164addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010165 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010166 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10167 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10168 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10169 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10170 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010172 Supported in default-server: No
10173
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010174agent-check
10175 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010176 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10177 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10178 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10179 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010180
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010181 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010182 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010183 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10184 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10185 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010186
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010187 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10188 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010189
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010190 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10191 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10192 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010193
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010194 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10195 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10196 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010197
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010198 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10199 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10200 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10201 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10202 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10203 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10204 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010205
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010206 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10207 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010208
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010209 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10210 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10211 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10212 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10213 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10214 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10215 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10216 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10217 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010218
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010219 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10220 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010221 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10222 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10223 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010224 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010225
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010226 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10227 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010228
10229 Supported in default-server: No
10230
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010231agent-send <string>
10232 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10233 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10234 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10235 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10236 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10237
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010238agent-inter <delay>
10239 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10240 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10241
10242 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10243 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10244 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10245 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10246 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10247 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10248 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10249 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10250 of backends use the same servers.
10251
10252 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10253
10254 Supported in default-server: Yes
10255
10256agent-port <port>
10257 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10258
10259 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10260
10261 Supported in default-server: Yes
10262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010263backup
10264 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10265 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10266 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10267 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10268 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10269 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010271 Supported in default-server: No
10272
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010273ca-file <cafile>
10274 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10275 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10276 server's certificate.
10277
10278 Supported in default-server: No
10279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010280check
10281 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010282 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10283 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10284 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10285 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10286 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10287 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10288 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010289 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10290 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10291 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010293 Supported in default-server: No
10294
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010295check-send-proxy
10296 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10297 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10298 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10299 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10300 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10301 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10302 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10303
10304 Supported in default-server: No
10305
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010306check-ssl
10307 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10308 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10309 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10310 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010311 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010312 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10313 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10314 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10315 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10316
10317 Supported in default-server: No
10318
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010319ciphers <ciphers>
10320 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010321 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010322 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10323 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10324 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10325 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10326 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10327 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10328
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010329 Supported in default-server: No
10330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010331cookie <value>
10332 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10333 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10334 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10335 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10336 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10337 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10338 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010340 Supported in default-server: No
10341
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010342crl-file <crlfile>
10343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10344 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10345 to verify server's certificate.
10346
10347 Supported in default-server: No
10348
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010349crt <cert>
10350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10351 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10352 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10353 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10354 certificate request.
10355
10356 Supported in default-server: No
10357
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010358disabled
10359 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10360 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10361 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10362 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10363 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10364
10365 Supported in default-server: No
10366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010367error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010368 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10369 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10370 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010371
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010372 Supported in default-server: Yes
10373
10374 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010376fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010377 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10378 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10379 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010381 Supported in default-server: Yes
10382
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010383force-sslv3
10384 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10385 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010386 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10387 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010388
10389 Supported in default-server: No
10390
10391force-tlsv10
10392 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010393 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10394 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010395
10396 Supported in default-server: No
10397
10398force-tlsv11
10399 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010400 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10401 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010402
10403 Supported in default-server: No
10404
10405force-tlsv12
10406 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010407 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10408 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010409
10410 Supported in default-server: No
10411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010412id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010413 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10414 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10415 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010416
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010417 Supported in default-server: No
10418
10419inter <delay>
10420fastinter <delay>
10421downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010422 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10423 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10424 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10425 between checks depending on the server state :
10426
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010427 Server state | Interval used
10428 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10429 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10430 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10431 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10432 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10433 or yet unchecked. |
10434 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10435 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10436 | "inter" otherwise.
10437 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010439 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10440 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10441 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10442 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010443 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10444 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10445 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10446 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10447 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010448
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010449 Supported in default-server: Yes
10450
10451maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010452 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10453 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10454 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10455 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10456 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10457 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10458 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10459 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010461 Supported in default-server: Yes
10462
10463maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010464 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10465 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10466 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10467 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10468 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10469 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10470 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010472 Supported in default-server: Yes
10473
10474minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010475 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10476 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10477 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10478 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10479 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10480 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010481 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010482 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010484 Supported in default-server: Yes
10485
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010486namespace <name>
10487 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10488 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10489 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10490 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10491
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010492no-ssl-reuse
10493 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10494 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10495 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10496 and for paranoid users.
10497
10498 Supported in default-server: No
10499
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010500no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010501 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10502 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010503 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010504
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010505 Supported in default-server: No
10506
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010507no-tls-tickets
10508 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10509 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10510 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010511 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10512 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010513
10514 Supported in default-server: No
10515
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010516no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010517 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010518 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10519 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010520 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10521 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10522 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010523
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010524 Supported in default-server: No
10525
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010526no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010527 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010528 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10529 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010530 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10531 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10532 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010533
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010534 Supported in default-server: No
10535
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010536no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010537 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010538 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10539 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010540 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10541 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10542 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010543
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010544 Supported in default-server: No
10545
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010546non-stick
10547 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10548 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10549 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10550
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010551 Supported in default-server: No
10552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010553observe <mode>
10554 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10555 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10556 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10557 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10558 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10559 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010560 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010562 Supported in default-server: No
10563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010564 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010566on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010567 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10568 Currently, four modes are available:
10569 - fastinter: force fastinter
10570 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10571 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10572 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10573 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010575 Supported in default-server: Yes
10576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010577 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10578
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010579on-marked-down <action>
10580 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10581 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010582 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10583 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10584 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10585 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10586 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10587 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10588 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10589 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010590
10591 Actions are disabled by default
10592
10593 Supported in default-server: Yes
10594
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010595on-marked-up <action>
10596 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10597 Currently one action is available:
10598 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10599 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10600 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10601 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10602 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10603 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10604 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10605 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10606
10607 Actions are disabled by default
10608
10609 Supported in default-server: Yes
10610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010611port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010612 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10613 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10614 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10615 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10616 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10617 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10618
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010619 Supported in default-server: Yes
10620
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010621redir <prefix>
10622 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10623 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10624 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10625 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10626 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10627 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10628 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10629 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010630 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010631 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10632 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10633 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10634 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10635 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10636
10637 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10638
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010639 Supported in default-server: No
10640
10641rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010642 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10643 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10644 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10645
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010646 Supported in default-server: Yes
10647
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010648resolve-prefer <family>
10649 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10650 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10651 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10652 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10653
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010654 Default value: ipv6
10655
10656 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010657
10658 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
10659
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010660resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10661 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10662 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10663 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10664 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10665 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10666 configured network, another address is selected.
10667
10668 Supported in default-server: Yes
10669
10670 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
10671
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010672resolvers <id>
10673 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10674 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010675 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10676 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10677 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10678 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010679
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010680 Supported in default-server: No
10681
10682 Example: server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010683
10684 See also chapter 5.3
10685
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010686send-proxy
10687 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10688 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10689 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10690 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
10691 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
10692 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
10693 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
10694 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
10695 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010696 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
10697 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
10698 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
10699 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
10700 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010701
10702 Supported in default-server: No
10703
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010704send-proxy-v2
10705 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10706 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10707 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10708 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10709 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10710 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10711 option of the "bind" keyword.
10712
10713 Supported in default-server: No
10714
10715send-proxy-v2-ssl
10716 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10717 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10718 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10719 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10720 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10721 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10722 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10723 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10724
10725 Supported in default-server: No
10726
10727send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10728 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10729 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10730 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10731 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10732 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10733 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10734 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10735 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10736 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10737
10738 Supported in default-server: No
10739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010740slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010741 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10742 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10743 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10744 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10745 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10746 parameters :
10747
10748 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10749 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10750
10751 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10752 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10753 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10754 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10755
10756 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10757 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10758 seen as failed.
10759
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010760 Supported in default-server: Yes
10761
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010762sni <expression>
10763 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10764 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10765 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10766 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10767 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10768
10769 Supported in default-server: no
10770
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010771source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010772source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010773source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010774 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10775 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10776 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10777 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10778
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010779 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10780 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10781 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10782 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10783 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10784 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10785 server.
10786
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010787 Supported in default-server: No
10788
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010789ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010790 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10791 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10792 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10793 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10794 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10795 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010796 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010797
10798 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010799
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010800tcp-ut <delay>
10801 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10802 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10803 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10804 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10805 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10806 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10807 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10808 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10809 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10810 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10811 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10812 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10813 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010815track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010816 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10817 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10818 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10819 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010820 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010822 Supported in default-server: No
10823
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010824verify [none|required]
10825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010826 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10827 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10828 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10829 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010830 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10831 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10832 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010833
10834 Supported in default-server: No
10835
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010836verifyhost <hostname>
10837 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10838 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10839 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10840 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10841 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10842 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10843
10844 Supported in default-server: No
10845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010846weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010847 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
10848 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
10849 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020010850 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
10851 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
10852 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
10853 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
10854 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
10855 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010857 Supported in default-server: Yes
10858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010859
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200108605.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
10861-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010862
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010863HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
10864using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
10865configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010866This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
10867can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
10868workload.
10869This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
10870resolution at run time.
10871Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
10872carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
10873
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010874Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
10875health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
10876
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010877
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200108785.3.1. Global overview
10879----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010880
10881As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
10882different steps of the process life:
10883
10884 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
10885 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
10886 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
10887
10888 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
10889 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
10890 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
10891
10892A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
10893 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
10894 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
10895 resolution to know this new IP.
10896
10897A few things important to notice:
10898 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
10899 first valid response.
10900
10901 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
10902 servers return an error.
10903
10904
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200109055.3.2. The resolvers section
10906----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010907
10908This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
10909HAProxy.
10910There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
10911many name servers.
10912
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010913When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
10914uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
10915is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
10916answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
10917
10918When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
10919used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
10920
10921Two types of behavior can be applied:
10922 1. stop DNS resolution
10923 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
10924 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
10925 1. ANY query type
10926 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
10927 server's parameter
10928 3. remaining family type
10929
10930HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
10931 - invalid DNS response packet
10932 - wrong name in the query section of the response
10933 - NX domain
10934 - Query refused by server
10935 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
10936
10937HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
10938 - no Answer records in the response
10939 - DNS response truncated
10940 - Error in DNS response
10941 - No expected DNS records found in the response
10942 - name server timeout
10943
10944For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
10945 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
10946 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
10947 applied;
10948 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
10949 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
10950 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
10951 stops resolution.
10952
10953
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010954resolvers <resolvers id>
10955 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
10956
10957A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
10958
10959nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
10960 DNS server description:
10961 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
10962 <ip> : IP address of the server
10963 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
10964
10965hold <status> <period>
10966 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
10967 on last resolution <status>
10968 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
10969 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
10970 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10971 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
10972
10973 Default value is 10s for "valid".
10974
10975 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
10976 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
10977 the healch check.
10978
10979resolve_retries <nb>
10980 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
10981 giving up.
10982 Default value: 3
10983
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010984 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
10985 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
10986 type.
10987
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010988timeout <event> <time>
10989 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
10990 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
10991 events available are:
10992 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
10993 been received.
10994 Default value: 1s
10995 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
10996 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
10997
10998Example of a resolvers section (with default values):
10999
11000 resolvers mydns
11001 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11002 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11003 resolve_retries 3
11004 timeout retry 1s
11005 hold valid 10s
11006
11007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110086. HTTP header manipulation
11009---------------------------
11010
11011In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11012response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11013request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11014which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011015against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011016
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011017If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11018to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11019but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11020HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11021stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11022because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11023a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11024still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011026This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11027in section 4.2 :
11028
11029 - reqadd <string>
11030 - reqallow <search>
11031 - reqiallow <search>
11032 - reqdel <search>
11033 - reqidel <search>
11034 - reqdeny <search>
11035 - reqideny <search>
11036 - reqpass <search>
11037 - reqipass <search>
11038 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11039 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11040 - reqtarpit <search>
11041 - reqitarpit <search>
11042 - rspadd <string>
11043 - rspdel <search>
11044 - rspidel <search>
11045 - rspdeny <search>
11046 - rspideny <search>
11047 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11048 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11049
11050With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11051is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11052parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11053prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11054Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11055
11056 \t for a tab
11057 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11058 \n for a new line (LF)
11059 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11060 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11061 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11062 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11063 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11064
11065The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11066portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11067above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11068regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
110699 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11070is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11071
11072The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11073after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11074
11075Notes related to these keywords :
11076---------------------------------
11077 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11078 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11079 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11080
11081 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11082 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11083 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11084
11085 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11086 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11087 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11088 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11089 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11090
11091 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11092 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11093 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11094 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11095 useless headers before adding new ones.
11096
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011097 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011098 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11099
11100 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11101 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11102 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11103
11104 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11105 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011106 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011107
11108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200111097. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11110----------------------------------
11111
11112Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11113client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11114The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11115these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11116but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11117data called patterns.
11118
11119
111207.1. ACL basics
11121---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011122
11123The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11124content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11125from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11126simple :
11127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011128 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011129 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011130 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11131 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011133The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11134adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011135
11136In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011138 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011139
11140This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11141Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11142and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011143an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11144conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11145as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11146are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011147
11148ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11149'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11150which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11151
11152There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11153performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011155The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11156specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11157this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011158methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11159ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011160
11161Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11162 - boolean
11163 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11164 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11165 - string
11166 - data block
11167
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011168Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11169converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11170would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11171The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11172which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11173
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011174Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11175keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11176fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11177which are summarized in the table below :
11178
11179 +---------------------+-----------------+
11180 | Sample or converter | Default |
11181 | output type | matching method |
11182 +---------------------+-----------------+
11183 | boolean | bool |
11184 +---------------------+-----------------+
11185 | integer | int |
11186 +---------------------+-----------------+
11187 | ip | ip |
11188 +---------------------+-----------------+
11189 | string | str |
11190 +---------------------+-----------------+
11191 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11192 +---------------------+-----------------+
11193
11194Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11195matching method, see below.
11196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011197The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11198 - boolean
11199 - integer or integer range
11200 - IP address / network
11201 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11202 - regular expression
11203 - hex block
11204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011205The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11206
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011207 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11208 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011209 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011210 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011211 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011212 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011213 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011215The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11216read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11217if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11218lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11219will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11220beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11221a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11222lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11223exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11224
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011225The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11226parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11227ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11228a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11229check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11230
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011231The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11232socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11233file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011235Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11236loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11237
11238 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11239
11240In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11241the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11242case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11243as well.
11244
11245The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11246sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11247do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11248methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11249is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11250obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11251followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11252default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11253that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11254string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11255
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011256The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11257By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11258string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11259resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11260server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11261waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11262flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11263function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011265There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11266sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11267be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011268
11269 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11270 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011271 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11272 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11273 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11274 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011275
11276 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11277 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011278 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011279
11280 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011281 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011282
11283 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011284 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011285
11286 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11287 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11288
11289 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11290 binary or string samples.
11291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011292 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11293 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011295 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11296 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11297 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011299 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11300 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011302 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11303 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011305 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11306 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011308 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11309 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011310 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011312 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11313 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11314 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011315
11316For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11317request, it is possible to do :
11318
11319 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11320
11321In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11322buffer, one would use the following acl :
11323
11324 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11325
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011326On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11327possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11328
11329 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011331All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11332criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11333method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11334to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11335criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11336the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011338If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011339the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11340For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011342 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11343 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11344 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11345 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011346
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011347
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011348The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11349types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11350combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11351brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11352default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354 +-------------------------------------------------+
11355 | Input sample type |
11356 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011357 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011358 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11359 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11360 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011361 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011362 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011363 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011364 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011365 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011366 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011367 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011368 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011369 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011370 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011371 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011372 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011373 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011374 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011375 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011376 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011377 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011378 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011379 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011380 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011381 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011382 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11383 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11384 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011385
11386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200113877.1.1. Matching booleans
11388------------------------
11389
11390In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11391Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11392When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11393that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11394
11395Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11396return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11397"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11398
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114007.1.2. Matching integers
11401------------------------
11402
11403Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11404enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11405to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11406
11407Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11408matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11409lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011410
11411For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11412unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11413representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11414
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011415As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11416two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11417instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11418ranges and operators.
11419
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011420For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011421operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11422Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11423of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011424
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011425Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011426
11427 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11428 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11429 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11430 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11431 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011433For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011434
11435 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11436
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011437This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11438
11439 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11440
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114427.1.3. Matching strings
11443-----------------------
11444
11445String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11446different forms :
11447
11448 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11449 patterns ;
11450
11451 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11452 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11453
11454 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11455 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11456
11457 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11458 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11459
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011460 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011461 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11462 matches.
11463
11464 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11465 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11466 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011467
11468String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11469exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11470characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11471string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11472to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011473before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011474
11475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114767.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11477---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011478
11479Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11480they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11481possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11482passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11483the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011484the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11485match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011486
11487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114887.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11489-------------------------------------
11490
11491It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11492not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11493a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11494to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11495digits may be used upper or lower case.
11496
11497Example :
11498 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11499 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11500
11501
115027.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11503---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011504
11505IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11506netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11507within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011508host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011509difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11510at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11511does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11512parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011513
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011514The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11515abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11516
11517 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11518 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11519 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11520 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11521 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11522 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11523 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11524 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11525
11526Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11527192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11528
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011529IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11530Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11531trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11532IPv6 patterns.
11533
11534HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11535following situations :
11536 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11537 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11538 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11539 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11540 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11541 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11542 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11543 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11544 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11545 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011547
115487.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11549----------------------------------
11550
11551Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11552combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11553
11554 - AND (implicit)
11555 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11556 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011558A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011560 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011562Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11563indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011565For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11566"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11567requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11568is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11569
11570 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11571 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11572 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11573 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11574
11575To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11576and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11577
11578 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11579 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11580 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11581 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11582
11583 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11584 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11585 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11586 use_backend www if host_www
11587
11588It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11589expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11590be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11591the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11592
11593 The following rule :
11594
11595 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11596 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11597
11598 Can also be written that way :
11599
11600 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11601
11602It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11603to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11604simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11605sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11606good use is the following :
11607
11608 With named ACLs :
11609
11610 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11611 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11612 monitor fail if site_dead
11613
11614 With anonymous ACLs :
11615
11616 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11617
11618See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11619
11620
116217.3. Fetching samples
11622---------------------
11623
11624Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11625against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11626sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11627ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11628of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11629available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11630
11631This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11632Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11633compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11634deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11635
11636The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11637matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11638method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11639indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11640
11641As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11642when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11643mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11644the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11645ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11646
11647Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11648multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11649when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11650incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11651are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11652is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11653all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11654
11655Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11656 - name
11657 - name(arg1)
11658 - name(arg1,arg2)
11659
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011660
116617.3.1. Converters
11662-----------------
11663
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011664Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11665of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11666is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11667was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11668has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11669unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11670
11671These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11672sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11673the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11674support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011675
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011676A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11677support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11678supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11679(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11680bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011682The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011683
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011684add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011685 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011686 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011687 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11688 scopes allowed are:
11689 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11690 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11691 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11692 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11693 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011694 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011695
11696and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011697 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011698 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011699 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11700 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11701 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11702 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11703 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11704 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11705 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011706 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011707
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011708base64
11709 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11710 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11711 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11712
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011713bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011714 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011715 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11716 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11717 presence of a flag).
11718
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011719bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11720 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11721 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11722 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11723
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011724cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011725 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11726 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011727
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011728crc32([<avalanche>])
11729 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11730 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11731 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11732 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11733 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11734 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11735 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11736 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11737 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11738 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11739 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11740
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011741da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011742 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11743 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11744 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11745 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011746 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011747 configuration language.
11748
11749 Example:
11750 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011751 bind *:8881
11752 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011753 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011754
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011755debug
11756 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11757 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11758 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11759
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011760div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011761 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11762 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011763 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011764 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11765 scope. The scopes allowed are:
11766 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11767 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11768 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11769 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11770 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011771 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011772
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011773djb2([<avalanche>])
11774 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11775 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11776 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11777 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11778 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11779 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11780 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011781 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11782 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011783
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011784even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011785 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011786 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11787
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011788field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11789 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11790 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11791 list of chars.
11792
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011793hex
11794 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11795 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11796 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11797 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011798
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011799http_date([<offset>])
11800 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11801 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11802 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11803 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11804 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11805 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011806
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011807in_table(<table>)
11808 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11809 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11810 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11811 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11812 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11813
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011814ipmask(<mask>)
11815 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11816 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11817 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11818 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11819
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011820json([<input-code>])
11821 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11822 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
11823 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
11824 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11825 of errors:
11826 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11827 bytes, ...)
11828 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11829 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11830
11831 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11832 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11833 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11834 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11835 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11836 are :
11837 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11838 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11839 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11840 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11841 error ;
11842 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11843 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11844
11845 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
11846 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
11847
11848 Example:
11849 capture request header user-agent len 150
11850 capture request header Host len 15
Mac Browninge83345d2016-03-14 14:46:01 -040011851 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json("utf8s")]"}
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011852
11853 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
11854 GET / HTTP/1.0
11855 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
11856
11857 Output log:
11858 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
11859
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011860language(<value>[,<default>])
11861 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
11862 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
11863 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
11864 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
11865 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
11866 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
11867 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
11868 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
11869 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
11870 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
11871 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
11872 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011873
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011874 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011875
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011876 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
11877 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011878
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011879 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
11880 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
11881 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
11882 use_backend spanish if es
11883 use_backend french if fr
11884 use_backend english if en
11885 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020011886
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011887lower
11888 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
11889 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
11890 type. The result is of type string.
11891
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020011892ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
11893 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11894 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
11895 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
11896 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
11897 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
11898 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
11899
11900 Example :
11901
11902 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
11903 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
11904 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
11905
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011906map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11907map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11908map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
11909 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
11910 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
11911 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
11912 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
11913 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
11914 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
11915 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
11916 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011917
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011918 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
11919 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
11920 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011921
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011922 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
11923 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011924
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011925 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
11926 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11927 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
11928 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020011929 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
11930 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011931 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
11932 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11933 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
11934 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11935 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
11936 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11937 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
11938 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010011939 | | map_reg | |
11940 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
11941 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011942 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11943 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
11944 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
11945 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
11946 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011947
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010011948 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
11949 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
11950 the corresponding match text.
11951
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011952 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
11953 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
11954 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
11955 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
11956 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010011957
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011958 Example :
11959
11960 # this is a comment and is ignored
11961 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
11962 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
11963 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
11964 | | | `---------- value
11965 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
11966 | `---------------------------- key
11967 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
11968
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011969mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011970 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11971 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011972 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011973 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11974 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11975 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11976 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11977 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11978 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011979 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011980
11981mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011982 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020011983 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
11984 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011985 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011986 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11987 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11988 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11989 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11990 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11991 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011992 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011993
11994neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011995 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
11996 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
11997 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
11998 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011999
12000not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012001 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012002 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12003 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12004 absence of a flag).
12005
12006odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012007 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012008 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12009
12010or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012011 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012012 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012013 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12014 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12015 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12016 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12017 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12018 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12019 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012020 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012021
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012022regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012023 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12024 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12025 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12026 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12027 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12028 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12029 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12030 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12031 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12032 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012033 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12034 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12035 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12036 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012037
12038 Example :
12039
12040 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12041 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12042 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12043 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12044
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012045capture-req(<id>)
12046 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12047 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12048
12049 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012050 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12051 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012052
12053capture-res(<id>)
12054 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12055 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12056
12057 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012058 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12059 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012060
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012061sdbm([<avalanche>])
12062 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12063 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12064 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12065 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12066 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12067 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12068 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012069 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12070 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012071
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012072set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012073 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12074 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12075 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12076 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12077 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012078 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012079 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12080 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012081 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12082 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12083
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012084sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012085 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12086 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012087 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012088 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12089 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12090 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12091 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012092 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012093 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12094 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012095 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12096 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012097
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012098table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12099 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12100 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12101 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12102 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12103 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12104 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12105
12106
12107table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12108 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12109 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12110 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12111 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12112 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12113 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12114
12115table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12116 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12117 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12118 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12119 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12120 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12121
12122table_conn_cur(<table>)
12123 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12124 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12125 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12126 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12127 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12128
12129table_conn_rate(<table>)
12130 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12131 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12132 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12133 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12134 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12135
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012136table_gpt0(<table>)
12137 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12138 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12139 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12140 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12141 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12142
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012143table_gpc0(<table>)
12144 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12145 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12146 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12147 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12148 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12149
12150table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12151 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12152 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12153 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12154 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12155 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12156 sample fetch keyword.
12157
12158table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12159 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12160 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12161 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12162 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12163 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12164
12165table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12166 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12167 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12168 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12169 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12170 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12171 keyword.
12172
12173table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12174 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12175 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12176 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12177 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12178 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12179
12180table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12181 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12182 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12183 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12184 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12185 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12186 keyword.
12187
12188table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12189 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12190 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12191 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12192 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12193 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12194 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12195 keyword.
12196
12197table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12198 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12199 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12200 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12201 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12202 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12203 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12204 keyword.
12205
12206table_server_id(<table>)
12207 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12208 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12209 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12210 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12211 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12212 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12213
12214table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12215 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12216 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12217 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12218 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12219 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12220 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12221 keyword.
12222
12223table_sess_rate(<table>)
12224 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12225 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12226 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12227 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12228 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12229 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12230 keyword.
12231
12232table_trackers(<table>)
12233 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12234 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12235 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12236 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12237 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12238 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12239 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12240 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12241 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12242 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12243
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012244upper
12245 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12246 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12247 type. The result is of type string.
12248
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012249url_dec
12250 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12251 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12252
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012253utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12254 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12255 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12256 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12257 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12258 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12259 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12260
12261 Example :
12262
12263 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12264 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12265 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12266
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012267word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12268 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12269 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12270
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012271wt6([<avalanche>])
12272 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12273 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12274 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12275 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12276 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12277 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12278 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012279 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12280 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012281
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012282xor(<value>)
12283 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012284 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012285 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012286 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12287 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12288 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012289 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012290 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12291 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012292 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12293 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012294
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012295
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200122967.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012297--------------------------------------------
12298
12299A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12300not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12301"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12302The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12303
12304always_false : boolean
12305 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12306 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12307
12308always_true : boolean
12309 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12310 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12311
12312avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012313 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012314 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12315 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12316 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12317 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12318 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12319 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12320 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12321 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12322 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12323 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12324 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12325 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12326 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012328be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012329 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12330 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12331 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12332 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12333 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012335be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12336 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12337 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12338 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12339 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12340 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12341 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012342
12343 Example :
12344 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12345 backend dynamic
12346 mode http
12347 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12348 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012349
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012350bin(<hexa>) : bin
12351 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12352 of the string.
12353
12354bool(<bool>) : bool
12355 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12356 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012358connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12359 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012360 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012361 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12362 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012363
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012364 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012365 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012366 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12367
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012368 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12369 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012370
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012371 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012372 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012373 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012374 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12375 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012376 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012377 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012378
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012379 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12380 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012381 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012382 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012383
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012384date([<offset>]) : integer
12385 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12386 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12387 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12388 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012389 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12390
12391 Example :
12392
12393 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12394 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012395
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012396env(<name>) : string
12397 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12398 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12399 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12400 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12401 certain way.
12402
12403 Examples :
12404 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12405 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12406
12407 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12408 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012410fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12411 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012412 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12413 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012414 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12415 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12416 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12417 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12418 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012420fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12421 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12422 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12423 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12424 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12425 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12426 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12427 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12428 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012429
12430 Example :
12431 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12432 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12433 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12434 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12435 frontend mail
12436 bind :25
12437 mode tcp
12438 maxconn 100
12439 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12440 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12441 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12442 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012443
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012444int(<integer>) : signed integer
12445 Returns a signed integer.
12446
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012447ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12448 Returns an ipv4.
12449
12450ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12451 Returns an ipv6.
12452
12453meth(<method>) : method
12454 Returns a method.
12455
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012456nbproc : integer
12457 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12458 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12459 and debugging purposes.
12460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012461nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12462 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12463 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12464 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012465 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12466 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12467 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012468
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012469proc : integer
12470 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12471 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12472 debugging purposes.
12473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012474queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012475 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12476 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12477 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012478 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12479 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12480 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12481 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12482 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12483
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012484rand([<range>]) : integer
12485 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12486 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12487 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12488 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12489 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012491srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12492 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12493 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12494 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12495 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12496 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12497 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12498 methods.
12499
12500srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12501 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12502 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12503 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12504 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12505 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12506 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12507 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12508
12509srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12510 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12511 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012512 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012513 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12514 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12515 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12516 overloading servers).
12517
12518 Example :
12519 # Redirect to a separate back
12520 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12521 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12522 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12523
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012524stopping : boolean
12525 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12526 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12527 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12528
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012529str(<string>) : string
12530 Returns a string.
12531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012532table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12533 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12534 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12535
12536table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12537 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12538 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12539 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12540
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012541var(<var-name>) : undefined
12542 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012543 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12544 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12545 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12546 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012547 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012548 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12549 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012550 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12551 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12552
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200125537.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012554----------------------------------
12555
12556The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12557closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12558methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12559sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12560TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012561the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12562counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12563"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012564argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12565the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12566this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012567
12568be_id : integer
12569 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12570 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12571
12572dst : ip
12573 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12574 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12575 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12576 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12577 RFC 4291.
12578
12579dst_conn : integer
12580 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12581 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12582 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12583 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12584 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12585 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12586 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12587 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012589dst_port : integer
12590 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12591 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12592 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12593 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12594 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12595 an HTTP header.
12596
12597fe_id : integer
12598 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12599 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12600 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12601
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012602sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012603sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12604sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12605sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012606 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12607 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12608 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12609
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012610sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012611sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12612sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12613sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012614 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12615 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12616 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12617
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012618sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012619sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12620sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12621sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012622 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12623 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012624 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12625 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12626 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012627
12628 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12629 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012630 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12631 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12632 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012633 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12634 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12635
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012636sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012637sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12638sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12639sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012640 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12641 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12642
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012643sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012644sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12645sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12646sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012647 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12648 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12649 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12650
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012651sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012652sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12653sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12654sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012655 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12656 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12657 See also src_conn_rate.
12658
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012659sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012660sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12661sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12662sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012663 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012664 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012665
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012666sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12667sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12668sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12669sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12670 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12671 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12672
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012673sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012674sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12675sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12676sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012677 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12678 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12679 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012680 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12681 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12682 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012683
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012684sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012685sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12686sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12687sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012688 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12689 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12690 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12691
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012692sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012693sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12694sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12695sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012696 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12697 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12698 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12699 src_http_err_rate.
12700
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012701sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012702sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12703sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12704sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012705 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12706 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12707 src_http_req_cnt.
12708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012709sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012710sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12711sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12712sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012713 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12714 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12715 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12716 src_http_req_rate.
12717
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012718sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012719sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12720sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12721sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012722 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012723 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12724 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12725 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12726 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012727
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012728 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12729 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012730 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12731
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012732sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012733sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12734sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12735sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012736 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12737 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12738 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012739
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012740sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012741sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12742sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12743sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012744 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12745 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12746 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012748sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012749sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12750sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12751sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012752 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12753 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12754 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12755 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012756 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012757 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12758
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012759sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012760sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12761sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12762sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012763 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12764 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12765 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12766 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12767 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012768 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012769
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012770sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012771sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12772sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12773sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012774 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12775 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12776 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12777
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012778sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012779sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12780sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12781sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012782 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12783 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012784 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012785 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
12786 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012787 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
12788 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
12789 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012791so_id : integer
12792 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
12793 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
12794 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012796src : ip
12797 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
12798 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
12799 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
12800 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
12801 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
12802 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
12803 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012804
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012805 Example:
12806 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
12807 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
12808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012809src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12810 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
12811 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
12812 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012813 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012815src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12816 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
12817 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012818 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012819 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12822 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12823 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12824 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
12825 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
12826 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
12827 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012828
12829 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12830 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
12831 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
12832 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012833 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012834 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12835 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012837src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012838 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012839 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012840 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012841 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012843src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012844 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012845 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
12846 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012847 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012849src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12850 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
12851 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12852 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012853 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012855src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012856 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012857 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012858 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012859 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012860
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012861src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12862 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12863 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
12864 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
12865 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
12866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012867src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012868 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012869 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012870 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
12871 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012872 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12873 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12874 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012876src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12877 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
12878 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012879 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012880 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012881 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012883src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12884 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
12885 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12886 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12887 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012888 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012890src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12891 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12892 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12893 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012894 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012896src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12897 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
12898 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
12899 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012900 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012901 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012903src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12904 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
12905 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12906 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012907 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
12909 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012910
12911 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012912 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012913 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012915src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012916 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
12917 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
12918 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
12919 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
12920 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012922src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012923 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
12924 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12925 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
12926 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
12927 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012929src_port : integer
12930 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
12931 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
12932 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
12933 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012935src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12936 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012937 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
12938 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
12939 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012940 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012942src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12943 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
12944 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
12945 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12946 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012947 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012949src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12950 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
12951 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
12952 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
12953 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
12954 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
12955 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
12956 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
12957 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012958
12959 Example :
12960 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
12961 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
12962 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
12963 listen ssh
12964 bind :22
12965 mode tcp
12966 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012967 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012968 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020012969 server local 127.0.0.1:22
12970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012971srv_id : integer
12972 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
12973 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
12974 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020012975
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010012976
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129777.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012978----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020012979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012980The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
12981closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
12982when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
12983usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012984future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020012985
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020012986ssl_bc : boolean
12987 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
12988 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
12989 other a server with the "ssl" option.
12990
12991ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
12992 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
12993 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12994
12995ssl_bc_cipher : string
12996 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
12997 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
12998
12999ssl_bc_protocol : string
13000 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13001 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13002
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013003ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013004 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013005 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13006 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013007
13008ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13009 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13010 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13011 if session was reused or not.
13012
13013ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13014 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13015 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013017ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13018 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13019 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13020 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13021 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13022 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013024ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13025 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13026 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13027 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13028 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013029
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013030ssl_c_der : binary
13031 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13032 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13033 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013035ssl_c_err : integer
13036 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13037 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13038 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13039 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13040 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13043 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13044 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13045 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13046 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13047 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13048 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13049 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13050 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013052ssl_c_key_alg : string
13053 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13054 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13055 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013057ssl_c_notafter : string
13058 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13059 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13060 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062ssl_c_notbefore : string
13063 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13064 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13065 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013067ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13068 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13069 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13070 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13071 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13072 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13073 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13074 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13075 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077ssl_c_serial : binary
13078 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13079 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13080 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013082ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13083 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13084 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13085 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013086 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13087 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13088
13089 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013091ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13092 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13093 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13094 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013096ssl_c_used : boolean
13097 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13098 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013100ssl_c_verify : integer
13101 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13102 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13103 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13104 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013106ssl_c_version : integer
13107 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13108 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013109
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013110ssl_f_der : binary
13111 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13112 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13113 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013115ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13116 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13117 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13118 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13119 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013120 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013121 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13122 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13123 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013125ssl_f_key_alg : string
13126 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13127 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13128 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013130ssl_f_notafter : string
13131 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13132 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13133 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013135ssl_f_notbefore : string
13136 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13137 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13138 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013140ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13141 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13142 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13143 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13144 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13145 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13146 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13147 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13148 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013150ssl_f_serial : binary
13151 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13152 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13153 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013154
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013155ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13156 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13157 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13158 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13161 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13162 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13163 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013165ssl_f_version : integer
13166 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13167 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13168
13169ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013170 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13171 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13172 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174 Example :
13175 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13176 listen http-https
13177 bind :80
13178 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13179 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13180
13181ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13182 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13183 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13184
13185ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013186 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013187 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13188 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13189 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13190 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13191 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13192 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13193 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13194 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013196ssl_fc_cipher : string
13197 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13198 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013200ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013201 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13202 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013203 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13204 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13205 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13206 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13209 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013210 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13211 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13212 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13213 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013214
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013215ssl_fc_is_resumed: boolean
13216 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13217 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013219ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013220 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013221 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13222 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13223 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13224 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13225 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13226 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13227 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013229ssl_fc_protocol : string
13230 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13231 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013232
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013233ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013234 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013235 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13236 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013238ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13239 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13240 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13241 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13242 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013244ssl_fc_sni : string
13245 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13246 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13247 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13248 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13249 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13250
13251 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13252 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13253 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013254 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13255 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013257 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013258 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13259 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13262 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13263 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013264
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013265
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132667.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013267------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013269Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13270sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13271only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13272For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13273be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13274can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13275sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13276for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13277content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013279payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13280 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13281 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13282 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13285 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13286 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13287 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013289req.len : integer
13290req_len : integer (deprecated)
13291 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13292 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13293 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13294 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13295 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13296 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13297 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13298 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013299
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013300req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13301 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013302 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13303 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13304 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13305 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013306
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013307 ACL alternatives :
13308 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013310req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13311 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13312 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13313 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13314 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013316 ACL alternatives :
13317 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013319 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013321req.proto_http : boolean
13322req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13323 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13324 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13325 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13326 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13327 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13328 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13329 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013331 Example:
13332 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13333 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13334 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013335 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013337req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13338rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13339 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13340 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13341 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13342 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13343 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13344 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13345 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013347 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13348 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13349 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13350 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13351 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13352 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013354 ACL derivatives :
13355 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013357 Example :
13358 listen tse-farm
13359 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13360 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13361 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13362 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13363 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13364 persist rdp-cookie
13365 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13366 # This is only useful makes sense if
13367 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13368 stick-table type string size 204800
13369 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13370 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13371 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013373 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13374 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013376req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13377rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13378 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13379 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13380 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13381 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013383 ACL derivatives :
13384 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013385
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013386req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13387 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13388 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013389 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13390 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13391 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13392 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13393 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013395req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13396req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13397 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13398 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13399 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13400 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13401 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13402 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13403 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013405req.ssl_sni : string
13406req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13407 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13408 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13409 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13410 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13411 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13412 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13413 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13414 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13415 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13416 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13417 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13418 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420 ACL derivatives :
13421 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423 Examples :
13424 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13425 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13426 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13427 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13428 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013429
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013430req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13431 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13432 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13433 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13434 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13435 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13436 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13437 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13438 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13439 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013441req.ssl_ver : integer
13442req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13443 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13444 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13445 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13446 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13447 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13448 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13449 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13450 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13451 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013452
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013453 ACL derivatives :
13454 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013455
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013456res.len : integer
13457 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13458 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13459 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13460 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13461 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13462 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13463 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13464 content inspection.
13465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013466res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13467 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013468 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13469 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13470 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13471 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13474 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13475 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13476 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13477 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013479 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013480
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013481res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13482rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13483 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13484 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13485 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13486 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13487 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13488 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13489 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013491wait_end : boolean
13492 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13493 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13494 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13495 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13496 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13497 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13498 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13499 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013501 Examples :
13502 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13503 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13504 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013506 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13507 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13508 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13509 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13510 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13511 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13512 tcp-request content reject
13513
13514
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135157.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013516--------------------------------------
13517
13518It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13519This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13520data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13521its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13522HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13523content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13524to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13525more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13526response are indexed.
13527
13528base : string
13529 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13530 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13531 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13532 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13533 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13534 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13535 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13536 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13537
13538 ACL derivatives :
13539 base : exact string match
13540 base_beg : prefix match
13541 base_dir : subdir match
13542 base_dom : domain match
13543 base_end : suffix match
13544 base_len : length match
13545 base_reg : regex match
13546 base_sub : substring match
13547
13548base32 : integer
13549 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13550 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13551 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013552 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13553 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13554 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013555
13556base32+src : binary
13557 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13558 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13559 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13560 per-URL counters.
13561
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013562capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13563 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13564 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13565 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13566
13567capture.req.method : string
13568 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13569 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13570 because it's allocated.
13571
13572capture.req.uri : string
13573 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13574 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13575 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13576 allocated.
13577
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013578capture.req.ver : string
13579 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13580 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13581 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13582
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013583capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13584 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13585 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13586 The first entry is an index of 0.
13587 See also: "capture response header"
13588
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013589capture.res.ver : string
13590 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13591 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13592 persistent flag.
13593
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013594req.body : binary
13595 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13596 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13597 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13598 the first chunk is analyzed.
13599
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013600req.body_param([<name>) : string
13601 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13602 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13603 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13604 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13605 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13606 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13607 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13608 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13609 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13610 given.
13611
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013612req.body_len : integer
13613 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13614 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13615 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13616 "option http-buffer-request".
13617
13618req.body_size : integer
13619 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13620 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13621 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13622 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13623 "option http-buffer-request".
13624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013625req.cook([<name>]) : string
13626cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13627 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13628 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13629 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13630 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13631 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13632 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13633 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13634 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13635
13636 ACL derivatives :
13637 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13638 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13639 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13640 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13641 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13642 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13643 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13644 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013646req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13647cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13648 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13649 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013651req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13652cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13653 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13654 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13655 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13656 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013658cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13659 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13660 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13661 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13662 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013663 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013664 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13665 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13666 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13667 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013669hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13670 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13671 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13672 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13673 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013674 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013676req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13677 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13678 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13679 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13680 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13681 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13682 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13683 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13684 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013686req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13687 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13688 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13689 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13690 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013692req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13693 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13694 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13695 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13696 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13697 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13698 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13699 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13700 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13701 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13702 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13703 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013705 ACL derivatives :
13706 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13707 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13708 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13709 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13710 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13711 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13712 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13713 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13714
13715req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13716hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13717 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13718 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13719 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13720 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13721 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13722 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13723 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13724 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13725 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13726
13727req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13728hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13729 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13730 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13731 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13732 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13733 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13734 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13735 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13736 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13737
13738req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13739hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13740 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13741 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13742 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13743 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13744 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13745 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13746 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13747
13748http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13749 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13750 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13751 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13752 basic auth is supported.
13753
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013754http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13755 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13756 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13757 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13758 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013759 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13760 basic auth is supported.
13761
13762 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013763 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13764 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13765 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13766 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013767
13768http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013769 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13770 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013771 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13772 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013774method : integer + string
13775 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
13776 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
13777 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
13778 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
13779 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
13780 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
13781 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013783 ACL derivatives :
13784 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013786 Example :
13787 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
13788 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
13789 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013791path : string
13792 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
13793 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
13794 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
13795 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
13796 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
13797 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
13798 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013800 ACL derivatives :
13801 path : exact string match
13802 path_beg : prefix match
13803 path_dir : subdir match
13804 path_dom : domain match
13805 path_end : suffix match
13806 path_len : length match
13807 path_reg : regex match
13808 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013809
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010013810query : string
13811 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
13812 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
13813 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
13814 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
13815 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
13816 which stops before the question mark.
13817
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013818req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13819 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13820 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13821 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13822 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013824req.ver : string
13825req_ver : string (deprecated)
13826 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
13827 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
13828 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013830 ACL derivatives :
13831 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013833res.comp : boolean
13834 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
13835 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
13836 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013838res.comp_algo : string
13839 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
13840 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
13841 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013843res.cook([<name>]) : string
13844scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13845 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13846 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13847 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013849 ACL derivatives :
13850 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020013851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013852res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13853scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13854 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13855 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
13856 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013858res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13859scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13860 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13861 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
13862 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013864res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13865 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13866 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13867 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13868 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13869 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
13870 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
13871 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
13872 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
13873 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013875res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13876 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13877 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13878 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13879 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
13880 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013882res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13883shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
13884 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
13885 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
13886 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
13887 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
13888 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
13889 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
13890 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
13891 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013893 ACL derivatives :
13894 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13895 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13896 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13897 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13898 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13899 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13900 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13901 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13902
13903res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13904shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13905 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
13906 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13907 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
13908 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
13909 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013911res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13912shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13913 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
13914 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
13915 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
13916 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
13917 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
13918 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013919
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010013920res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
13921 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
13922 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
13923 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
13924 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
13925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13927shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13928 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
13929 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13930 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13931 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13932 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
13933 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935res.ver : string
13936resp_ver : string (deprecated)
13937 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
13938 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013940 ACL derivatives :
13941 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010013942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013943set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13944 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
13945 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013946 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013949 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
13950 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010013951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013952status : integer
13953 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
13954 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
13955 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013956
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020013957unique-id : string
13958 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
13959 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
13960 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
13961 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
13962 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
13963 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
13964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013965url : string
13966 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
13967 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
13968 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
13969 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
13970 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
13971 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
13972 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974 ACL derivatives :
13975 url : exact string match
13976 url_beg : prefix match
13977 url_dir : subdir match
13978 url_dom : domain match
13979 url_end : suffix match
13980 url_len : length match
13981 url_reg : regex match
13982 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013984url_ip : ip
13985 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
13986 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
13987 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
13988 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
13989 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
13990 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13991 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993url_port : integer
13994 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
13995 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
13996 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
13997 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020013998
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020013999urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14000url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014001 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14002 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014003 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14004 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14005 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14006 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014007 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14008 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014009 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14010 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014012 ACL derivatives :
14013 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14014 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14015 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14016 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14017 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14018 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14019 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14020 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014021
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014023 Example :
14024 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14025 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14026 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14027 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014028
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014029urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014030 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14031 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14032 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014033
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140357.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014036---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014038Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14039every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014040order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014042ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14043---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014044FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014045HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014046HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14047HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014048HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14049HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14050HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14051HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14052LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014053METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014054METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014055METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14056METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14057METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14058METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014059METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014060METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014061RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014062REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014063TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014064WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14065---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014066
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140688. Logging
14069----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014070
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014071One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14072provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14073very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14074provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14075state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014076to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014077headers.
14078
14079In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14080about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14081send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14082
14083 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14084 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14085 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14086 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14087 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014088 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14089 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014090
14091The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14092allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14093as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14094while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14095real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14096delay.
14097
14098
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140998.1. Log levels
14100---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014101
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014102TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014103source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014104HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14105in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14106track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14107syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14108about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014109
14110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141118.2. Log formats
14112----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014113
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014114HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014115and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14116slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14117options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014118
14119 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14120 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14121 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14122 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14123 extents.
14124
14125 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14126 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14127 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14128 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14129 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14130
14131 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14132 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14133 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14134 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14135 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14136
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014137 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14138 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14139 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14140 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14141
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014142 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14143
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014144Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14145specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14146field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14147servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14148always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14149identifier.
14150
14151Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14152 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14153 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14154 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14155 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14156
14157
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141588.2.1. Default log format
14159-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014160
14161This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14162as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14163format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14164
14165 Example :
14166 listen www
14167 mode http
14168 log global
14169 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14170
14171 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14172 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14173 (www/HTTP)
14174
14175 Field Format Extract from the example above
14176 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14177 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14178 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14179 4 'to' to
14180 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14181 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14182
14183Detailed fields description :
14184 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14185 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14186 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14187 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14188 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14189 and processed the connection.
14190 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14191
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014192In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14193"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14194connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14195
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014196It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14197will eventually disappear.
14198
14199
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142008.2.2. TCP log format
14201---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014202
14203The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14204is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14205information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14206counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14207emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14208environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14209the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14210sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014211specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14212not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14213fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14214marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014215
14216 Example :
14217 frontend fnt
14218 mode tcp
14219 option tcplog
14220 log global
14221 default_backend bck
14222
14223 backend bck
14224 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14225
14226 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14227 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14228 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14229
14230 Field Format Extract from the example above
14231 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14232 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14233 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14234 4 frontend_name fnt
14235 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14236 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14237 7 bytes_read* 212
14238 8 termination_state --
14239 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14240 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14241
14242Detailed fields description :
14243 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014244 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14245 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14246 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14247 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14248 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014249
14250 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014251 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14252 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14253 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014254
14255 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14256 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14257 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14258 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14259
14260 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14261 and processed the connection.
14262
14263 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14264 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14265 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14266 applications.
14267
14268 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14269 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14270 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14271 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14272 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14273
14274 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14275 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14276 See "Timers" below for more details.
14277
14278 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14279 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14280 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14281 "Timers" below for more details.
14282
14283 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014284 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014285 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14286 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14287 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14288 details.
14289
14290 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14291 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14292 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14293 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14294 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14295
14296 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14297 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14298 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14299 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14300 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14301 for more details.
14302
14303 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014304 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014305 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14306 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14307 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014308 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014309
14310 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14311 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14312 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14313 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14314 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14315 caused by a denial of service attack.
14316
14317 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14318 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14319 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14320 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14321 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14322 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14323 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14324 denial of service attack.
14325
14326 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14327 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14328 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14329 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14330 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14331 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14332 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14333 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14334 be processed than on other servers.
14335
14336 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14337 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14338 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14339 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14340 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14341 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14342 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14343 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14344 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14345 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14346 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14347 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14348 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14349
14350 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14351 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14352 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14353 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14354 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14355 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14356 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14357 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14358
14359 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14360 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14361 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14362 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14363 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14364 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14365 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14366 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14367 occurs.
14368
14369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143708.2.3. HTTP log format
14371----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014372
14373The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14374is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14375the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14376are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14377emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14378generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14379"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14380which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014381frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14382is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014383
14384Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14385slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14386with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14387
14388 Example :
14389 frontend http-in
14390 mode http
14391 option httplog
14392 log global
14393 default_backend bck
14394
14395 backend static
14396 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14397
14398 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14399 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14400 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014401 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014402
14403 Field Format Extract from the example above
14404 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14405 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
14406 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
14407 4 frontend_name http-in
14408 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
14409 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
14410 7 status_code 200
14411 8 bytes_read* 2750
14412 9 captured_request_cookie -
14413 10 captured_response_cookie -
14414 11 termination_state ----
14415 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14416 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14417 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14418 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14419 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014420
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014421
14422Detailed fields description :
14423 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014424 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14425 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14426 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
14427 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
14428 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014429
14430 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014431 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14432 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14433 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014434
14435 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
14436 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
14437 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
14438 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
14439 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
14440
14441 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14442 and processed the connection.
14443
14444 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14445 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14446 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14447
14448 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14449 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14450 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14451 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14452 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14453 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14454
14455 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
14456 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
14457 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
14458 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
14459 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
14460 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
14461
14462 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14463 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14464 See "Timers" below for more details.
14465
14466 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14467 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14468 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14469 below for more details.
14470
14471 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14472 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14473 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14474 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14475 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14476 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14477 for more details.
14478
14479 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014480 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014481 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14482 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14483 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14484 details.
14485
14486 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14487 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14488 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14489
14490 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14491 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14492 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14493 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14494 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14495 overflowing.
14496
14497 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14498 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14499 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14500 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14501 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14502 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14503 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14504 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14505
14506 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14507 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14508 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14509 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14510 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14511 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14512 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14513 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14514
14515 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14516 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14517 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14518 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14519 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14520 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14521 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14522
14523 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014524 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014525 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14526 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14527 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014528 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014529 system.
14530
14531 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14532 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14533 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14534 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14535 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14536 caused by a denial of service attack.
14537
14538 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14539 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14540 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14541 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14542 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14543 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14544 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14545 denial of service attack.
14546
14547 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14548 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14549 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14550 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14551 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14552 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14553 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14554 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14555 processed than on other servers.
14556
14557 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14558 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14559 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14560 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14561 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14562 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14563 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14564 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14565 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14566 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14567 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14568 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14569 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14570
14571 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14572 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14573 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14574 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14575 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14576 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14577 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14578 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14579
14580 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14581 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14582 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14583 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14584 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14585 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14586 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14587 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14588 occurs.
14589
14590 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14591 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14592 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14593 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14594 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14595 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14596 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14597 cookies" below for more details.
14598
14599 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14600 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14601 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14602 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14603 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14604 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14605 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14606 and cookies" below for more details.
14607
14608 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14609 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14610 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14611 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14612 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14613 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14614 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14615 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14616
14617
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200146188.2.4. Custom log format
14619------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014620
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014621The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014622mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014623
14624HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14625Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14626separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14627prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14628
14629Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14630variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014631("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014632
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014633If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014634as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014635less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14636the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14637
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014638Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014639In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014640in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014641
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014642Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14643'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14644https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14645such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14646
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014647Flags are :
14648 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014649 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014650 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14651 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014652
14653 Example:
14654
14655 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14656 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14657
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014658 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
14659
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014660At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14661
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014662 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
14663 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014664
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014665the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014666
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014667 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014668 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014669 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014670
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014671and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14672
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014673 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014674 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
14675
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014676Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14677
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014678 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014679 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014680 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14681 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14682 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014683 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14684 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14685 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014686 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014687 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14688 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014689 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014690 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14691 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014692 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014693 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014694 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014695 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014696 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014697 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
14698 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014699 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014700 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14701 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014702 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014703 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14704 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014705 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14706 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14707 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014708 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014709 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14710 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014711 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014712 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14713 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14714 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014715 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014716 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014717 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14718 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14719 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14720 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014721 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014722 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014723 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014724 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014725 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014726 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014727 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14728 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14729 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014730 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014731 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14732 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014733 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014734 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014735 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014736 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014737
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014738 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014739
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014740
147418.2.5. Error log format
14742-----------------------
14743
14744When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14745protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14746By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14747"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14748will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14749logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14750
14751The format looks like this :
14752
14753 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
14754 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
14755 Connection error during SSL handshake
14756
14757 Field Format Extract from the example above
14758 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
14759 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
14760 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
14761 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
14762 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
14763
14764These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
14765failures.
14766
14767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147688.3. Advanced logging options
14769-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014770
14771Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
14772just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
14773options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
14774for more information about their usage.
14775
14776
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147778.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
14778------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014779
14780It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
14781haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
14782commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
14783monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
14784ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
14785
14786 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
14787 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
14788 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
14789 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
14790
14791 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
14792 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
14793 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014794 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014795 such as other load-balancers.
14796
14797 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
14798 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
14799 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
14800
14801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148028.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
14803----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014804
14805The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
14806what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
14807or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
14808"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
14809just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
14810log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
14811after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
14812is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
14813with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
14814with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
14815
14816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148178.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
14818------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014819
14820Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
14821for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
14822"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
14823retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
14824raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
14825a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
14826file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
14827you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
14828"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
14829
14830
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148318.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
14832--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014833
14834Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
14835multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
14836them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
14837"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
14838logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
14839error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
14840and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
14841too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
14842useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
14843alternative.
14844
14845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148468.4. Timing events
14847------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014848
14849Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
14850reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
14851the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
14852frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
14853mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
14854
14855 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
14856 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
14857 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
14858 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
14859 the client closes prematurely or times out.
14860
14861 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
14862 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
14863 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
14864 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
14865 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
14866
14867 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
14868 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
14869 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
14870 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
14871 connection never established.
14872
14873 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
14874 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
14875 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
14876 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
14877 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
14878 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
14879 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
14880 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
14881 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
14882 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
14883 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
14884
14885 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
14886 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
14887 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
14888 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014889 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014890
14891 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
14892
14893 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
14894 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
14895 negative.
14896
14897These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
14898protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
14899that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014900due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014901close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
14902session has been aborted on timeout.
14903
14904Most common cases :
14905
14906 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14907 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
14908 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
14909 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
14910 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
14911 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
14912 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
14913 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
14914 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010014915 connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive modes
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020014916 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
14917 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014918
14919 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
14920 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
14921 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
14922 of ms on remote networks.
14923
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014924 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
14925 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
14926 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014927
14928 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
14929 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
14930 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
14931 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
14932 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
14933 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
14934 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
14935 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
14936 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
14937 to the server until another one is released.
14938
14939Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
14940
14941 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
14942 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
14943 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
14944
14945 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
14946 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
14947 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
14948
14949 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
14950 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
14951 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
14952 flags.
14953
14954 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
14955 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
14956 Check the session termination flags, then check the
14957 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
14958 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
14959 the client connection was maintained open.
14960
14961 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014962 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014963 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
14964 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
14965
14966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149678.5. Session state at disconnection
14968-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014969
14970TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
14971"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
149722-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
14973each of which has a special meaning :
14974
14975 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
14976 session to terminate :
14977
14978 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
14979
14980 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
14981 server explicitly refused it.
14982
14983 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
14984 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
14985 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
14986 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020014987 (eg: cacheable cookie).
14988
14989 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
14990 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014991
14992 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
14993 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
14994 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
14995 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
14996 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
14997
14998 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
14999 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15000 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15001 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15002 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15003
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015004 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15005 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15006
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015007 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15008 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15009 backup connections when going up.
15010
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015011 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15012
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015013 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15014 send or receive data.
15015
15016 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15017 send or receive data.
15018
15019 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15020 with nothing left in the buffers.
15021
15022 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15023
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015024 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015025 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15026
15027 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15028 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15029 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15030 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15031 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15032
15033 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15034 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15035
15036 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15037 server (HTTP only).
15038
15039 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15040
15041 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15042 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15043 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15044
15045 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15046 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15047 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15048
15049 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15050
15051 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15052 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15053
15054 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15055 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15056 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15057
15058 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15059 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015060 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15061 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015062
15063 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15064 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15065 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15066 another server.
15067
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015068 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015069 server.
15070
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015071 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15072 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15073 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15074 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15075
15076 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15077 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15078 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15079 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15080
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015081 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15082 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15083 "use-server" rule).
15084
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015085 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15086
15087 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15088 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15089
15090 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15091
15092 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15093 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15094 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15095
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015096 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15097 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015098 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015099 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15100 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15101
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015102 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15103
15104 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15105 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15106
15107 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15108
15109 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15110
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015111The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15112was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015113helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15114starvation, attacks, etc...
15115
15116The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15117alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15118easier finding and understanding.
15119
15120 Flags Reason
15121
15122 -- Normal termination.
15123
15124 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15125 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15126 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15127 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15128
15129 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15130 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15131 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15132 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15133 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15134 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015135
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015136 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15137 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015138 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015139
15140 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15141 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15142 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15143
15144 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15145 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15146 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15147 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15148 the server takes too long to respond.
15149
15150 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15151 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15152 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15153 long a time to respond.
15154
15155 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15156 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15157 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15158 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015159 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15160 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015161
15162 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15163 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15164 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15165 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15166 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015167 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015168 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15169 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15170 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15171 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15172 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15173 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15174 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15175 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15176 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15177 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15178 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15179 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015180
15181 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15182 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015183 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15184 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15185 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15186 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015187
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015188 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15189 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15190
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015191 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015192 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15193 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15194 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15195 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15196 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15197
15198 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15199 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15200 503 or 504 here.
15201
15202 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15203 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15204 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15205 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15206 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15207
15208 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15209 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015210 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015211 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15212 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15213
15214 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15215 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15216 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15217 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15218 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15219 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15220 between haproxy and the server.
15221
15222 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15223 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15224 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15225 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15226 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15227 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15228 solution is to fix the application.
15229
15230 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15231 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15232 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15233 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15234 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15235 external attacks.
15236
15237 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15238 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015239 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015240 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15241 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15242
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015243 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15244 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15245 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015246 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15247 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015248
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015249 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15250 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15251 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15252 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015253 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15254 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15255 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15256 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15257 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015258
15259 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15260 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15261 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15262 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15263
15264 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15265 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15266 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15267 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15268
15269 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15270 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15271 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15272 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15273
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015274The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15275persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15276important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15277re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15278
15279 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15280
15281 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15282 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15283 set on a GET request.
15284
15285 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15286 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015287 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015288 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15289
15290 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15291 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15292 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15293
15294 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15295 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15296 already got a cookie.
15297
15298 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15299 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15300 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15301 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15302 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15303
15304 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15305 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15306 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15307
15308 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15309 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15310 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15311
15312 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15313 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15314
15315 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15316 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15317 then advertised in the response.
15318
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153208.6. Non-printable characters
15321-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015322
15323In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15324consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15325converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15326prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15327being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15328escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15329is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15330'}' when logging headers.
15331
15332Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15333issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15334containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15335
15336Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15337the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15338performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15339
15340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153418.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15342---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015343
15344Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15345achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015346section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015347cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15348the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15349the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015350locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015351not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15352user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15353a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15354wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15355
15356 Examples :
15357 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15358 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15359
15360 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15361 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15362
15363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153648.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15365---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015366
15367Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15368proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15369the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15370server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15371
15372Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15373response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015374section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015375
15376It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015377time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15378appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015379are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15380and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15381follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15382request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15383in the logs.
15384
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015385As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15386frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15387an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15388
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015389 Example :
15390 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15391 listen proxy-out
15392 mode http
15393 option httplog
15394 option logasap
15395 log global
15396 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15397
15398 # log the name of the virtual server
15399 capture request header Host len 20
15400
15401 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15402 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15403
15404 # log the beginning of the referrer
15405 capture request header Referer len 20
15406
15407 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15408 capture response header Server len 20
15409
15410 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15411 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15412
15413 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15414 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15415
15416 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15417 capture response header Via len 20
15418
15419 # log the URL location during a redirection
15420 capture response header Location len 20
15421
15422 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15423 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15424 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15425 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15426 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15427
15428 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15429 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15430 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15431 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015432 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015433
15434 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15435 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15436 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15437 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15438 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015439 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015440
15441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154428.9. Examples of logs
15443---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015444
15445These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15446them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15447reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15448
15449 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15450 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15451 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15452
15453 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15454 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15455
15456 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15457 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15458 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15459
15460 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15461 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15462
15463 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15464 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15465 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15466
15467 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015468 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015469 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15470 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15471
15472 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15473 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15474 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15475
15476 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15477 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015478 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015479 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15480 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15481 to return the 502 and not the server.
15482
15483 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015484 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015485
15486 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15487 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15488 Nothing was sent to any server.
15489
15490 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15491 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15492
15493 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15494 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15495 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15496 send a 408 return code to the client.
15497
15498 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15499 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15500
15501 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15502 5 seconds ("c----").
15503
15504 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15505 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015506 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015507
15508 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015509 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015510 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15511 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15512 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15513 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15514 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015515
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015516
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200155179. Supported filters
15518--------------------
15519
15520Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
15521accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
15522unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
15523
15524See also : "filter"
15525
155269.1. Trace
15527----------
15528
15529filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
15530
15531 Arguments:
15532 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
15533 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
15534
15535 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
15536 the client and the server. By default, this filter
15537 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
15538 only parses a random amount of the available data.
15539
15540 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
15541 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
15542 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
15543 amount of the parsed data.
15544
15545This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
15546callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
15547information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
15548filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
15549
15550Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
15551tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
15552a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
15553
15554
155559.2. HTTP compression
15556---------------------
15557
15558filter compression
15559
15560The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
15561keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
15562when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
15563use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
15564used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
15565filters evaluation order.
15566
15567See also : "compression"
15568
15569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015570/*
15571 * Local variables:
15572 * fill-column: 79
15573 * End:
15574 */